1 |
38 |
julius |
@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
|
2 |
|
|
@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
3 |
|
|
@c This is part of the GCC manual.
|
4 |
|
|
@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
|
5 |
|
|
|
6 |
|
|
@node Target Macros
|
7 |
|
|
@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
|
8 |
|
|
@cindex machine description macros
|
9 |
|
|
@cindex target description macros
|
10 |
|
|
@cindex macros, target description
|
11 |
|
|
@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
|
12 |
|
|
|
13 |
|
|
In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
|
14 |
|
|
includes a C header file conventionally given the name
|
15 |
|
|
@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
|
16 |
|
|
The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
|
17 |
|
|
about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
|
18 |
|
|
@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
|
19 |
|
|
@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
|
20 |
|
|
@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
|
21 |
|
|
source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
|
22 |
|
|
containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
|
23 |
|
|
machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
|
24 |
|
|
if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
|
25 |
|
|
through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
|
26 |
|
|
|
27 |
|
|
@menu
|
28 |
|
|
* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
|
29 |
|
|
* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
|
30 |
|
|
* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
|
31 |
|
|
* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
|
32 |
|
|
* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
|
33 |
|
|
* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
|
34 |
|
|
* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
|
35 |
|
|
* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
|
36 |
|
|
* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
|
37 |
|
|
* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
|
38 |
|
|
* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
|
39 |
|
|
* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
|
40 |
|
|
* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
|
41 |
|
|
* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
|
42 |
|
|
* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
|
43 |
|
|
* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
|
44 |
|
|
* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
|
45 |
|
|
* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
|
46 |
|
|
* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
|
47 |
|
|
* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
|
48 |
|
|
* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
|
49 |
|
|
* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
|
50 |
|
|
* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
|
51 |
|
|
* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
|
52 |
|
|
* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
|
53 |
|
|
* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
|
54 |
|
|
* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
|
55 |
|
|
* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
|
56 |
|
|
* Misc:: Everything else.
|
57 |
|
|
@end menu
|
58 |
|
|
|
59 |
|
|
@node Target Structure
|
60 |
|
|
@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
|
61 |
|
|
@cindex target hooks
|
62 |
|
|
@cindex target functions
|
63 |
|
|
|
64 |
|
|
@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
|
65 |
|
|
The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
|
66 |
|
|
which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
|
67 |
|
|
machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
|
68 |
|
|
@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
|
69 |
|
|
used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
|
70 |
|
|
for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
|
71 |
|
|
macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
|
72 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
73 |
|
|
#include "target.h"
|
74 |
|
|
#include "target-def.h"
|
75 |
|
|
|
76 |
|
|
/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
|
77 |
|
|
|
78 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
|
79 |
|
|
#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
|
80 |
|
|
|
81 |
|
|
struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
|
82 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
83 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
84 |
|
|
|
85 |
|
|
Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
|
86 |
|
|
form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
|
87 |
|
|
``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
|
88 |
|
|
from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
|
89 |
|
|
@code{targetm} structure.
|
90 |
|
|
|
91 |
|
|
@node Driver
|
92 |
|
|
@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
|
93 |
|
|
@cindex driver
|
94 |
|
|
@cindex controlling the compilation driver
|
95 |
|
|
|
96 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
97 |
|
|
You can control the compilation driver.
|
98 |
|
|
|
99 |
|
|
@defmac SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
|
100 |
|
|
A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
|
101 |
|
|
takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
|
102 |
|
|
option takes--zero, for many options.
|
103 |
|
|
|
104 |
|
|
By default, this macro is defined as
|
105 |
|
|
@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
|
106 |
|
|
properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
|
107 |
|
|
wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
|
108 |
|
|
should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
|
109 |
|
|
additional options.
|
110 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
111 |
|
|
|
112 |
|
|
@defmac WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
|
113 |
|
|
A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
|
114 |
|
|
takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
|
115 |
|
|
option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
|
116 |
|
|
@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
|
117 |
|
|
|
118 |
|
|
By default, this macro is defined as
|
119 |
|
|
@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
|
120 |
|
|
properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
|
121 |
|
|
wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
|
122 |
|
|
should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
|
123 |
|
|
additional options.
|
124 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
125 |
|
|
|
126 |
|
|
@defmac SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
|
127 |
|
|
A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
|
128 |
|
|
stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
|
129 |
|
|
boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
|
130 |
|
|
generated, zero otherwise.
|
131 |
|
|
|
132 |
|
|
By default, this macro is defined as
|
133 |
|
|
@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
|
134 |
|
|
options properly. You need not define
|
135 |
|
|
@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
|
136 |
|
|
options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
|
137 |
|
|
should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
|
138 |
|
|
for additional options.
|
139 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
140 |
|
|
|
141 |
|
|
@defmac SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
|
142 |
|
|
A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
|
143 |
|
|
the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
|
144 |
|
|
|
145 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
|
146 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
147 |
|
|
|
148 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
|
149 |
|
|
If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
|
150 |
|
|
potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
|
151 |
|
|
second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
|
152 |
|
|
supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
|
153 |
|
|
target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
|
154 |
|
|
are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
|
155 |
|
|
must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
|
156 |
|
|
provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
|
157 |
|
|
such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
|
158 |
|
|
multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @option{-malt-abi},
|
159 |
|
|
@option{-EB}, and @option{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
|
160 |
|
|
|
161 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
162 |
|
|
#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
|
163 |
|
|
@{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
|
164 |
|
|
@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
|
165 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
166 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
167 |
|
|
|
168 |
|
|
@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
|
169 |
|
|
A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
|
170 |
|
|
initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
|
171 |
|
|
|
172 |
|
|
The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
|
173 |
|
|
default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
|
174 |
|
|
choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
|
175 |
|
|
applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
|
176 |
|
|
options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
|
177 |
|
|
using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
|
178 |
|
|
|
179 |
|
|
This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
|
180 |
|
|
options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
|
181 |
|
|
that the other specs are easier to write.
|
182 |
|
|
|
183 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
184 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
185 |
|
|
|
186 |
|
|
@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
|
187 |
|
|
A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
|
188 |
|
|
@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
|
189 |
|
|
for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
|
190 |
|
|
outermost pair of surrounding braces.
|
191 |
|
|
|
192 |
|
|
The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
|
193 |
|
|
the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
|
194 |
|
|
to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
|
195 |
|
|
@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
|
196 |
|
|
everywhere it occurs.
|
197 |
|
|
|
198 |
|
|
The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
|
199 |
|
|
default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
|
200 |
|
|
the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
|
201 |
|
|
|
202 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
203 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
204 |
|
|
|
205 |
|
|
@defmac CPP_SPEC
|
206 |
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
|
207 |
|
|
pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
|
208 |
|
|
give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
|
209 |
|
|
|
210 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
211 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
212 |
|
|
|
213 |
|
|
@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
|
214 |
|
|
This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
|
215 |
|
|
than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
|
216 |
|
|
@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
|
217 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
218 |
|
|
|
219 |
|
|
@defmac CC1_SPEC
|
220 |
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
|
221 |
|
|
pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
|
222 |
|
|
front ends.
|
223 |
|
|
It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
|
224 |
|
|
for GCC to pass to front ends.
|
225 |
|
|
|
226 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
227 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
228 |
|
|
|
229 |
|
|
@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
|
230 |
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
|
231 |
|
|
pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
|
232 |
|
|
give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
|
233 |
|
|
|
234 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
235 |
|
|
Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
|
236 |
|
|
@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
|
237 |
|
|
CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
|
238 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
239 |
|
|
|
240 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_SPEC
|
241 |
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
|
242 |
|
|
pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
|
243 |
|
|
you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
|
244 |
|
|
See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
|
245 |
|
|
|
246 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
247 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
248 |
|
|
|
249 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
|
250 |
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
|
251 |
|
|
run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
|
252 |
|
|
Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
|
253 |
|
|
an example of this.
|
254 |
|
|
|
255 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
256 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
257 |
|
|
|
258 |
|
|
@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
|
259 |
|
|
Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
|
260 |
|
|
an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
|
261 |
|
|
read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
|
262 |
|
|
output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
|
263 |
|
|
@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
|
264 |
|
|
|
265 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
|
266 |
|
|
standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
|
267 |
|
|
cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
|
268 |
|
|
see @file{mips.h} for instance.
|
269 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
270 |
|
|
|
271 |
|
|
@defmac LINK_SPEC
|
272 |
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
|
273 |
|
|
pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
|
274 |
|
|
give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
|
275 |
|
|
|
276 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
277 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
278 |
|
|
|
279 |
|
|
@defmac LIB_SPEC
|
280 |
|
|
Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
|
281 |
|
|
between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
|
282 |
|
|
command given to the linker.
|
283 |
|
|
|
284 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
|
285 |
|
|
loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
|
286 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
287 |
|
|
|
288 |
|
|
@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
|
289 |
|
|
Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
|
290 |
|
|
how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
|
291 |
|
|
linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
|
292 |
|
|
the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
|
293 |
|
|
|
294 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
|
295 |
|
|
passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
|
296 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
297 |
|
|
|
298 |
|
|
@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
|
299 |
|
|
By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
|
300 |
|
|
@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
|
301 |
|
|
instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
|
302 |
|
|
depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
|
303 |
|
|
@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
|
304 |
|
|
targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
|
305 |
|
|
@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
|
306 |
|
|
driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
|
307 |
|
|
line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
|
308 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
309 |
|
|
|
310 |
|
|
@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
|
311 |
|
|
A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
|
312 |
|
|
mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
|
313 |
|
|
generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
|
314 |
|
|
static exception handler library, when linking without any of
|
315 |
|
|
@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
|
316 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
317 |
|
|
|
318 |
|
|
@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
|
319 |
|
|
If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
|
320 |
|
|
When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
|
321 |
|
|
the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
|
322 |
|
|
@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
|
323 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
324 |
|
|
|
325 |
|
|
@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
|
326 |
|
|
Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
|
327 |
|
|
difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
|
328 |
|
|
the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
|
329 |
|
|
|
330 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
|
331 |
|
|
standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
|
332 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
333 |
|
|
|
334 |
|
|
@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
|
335 |
|
|
Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
|
336 |
|
|
difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
|
337 |
|
|
the very end of the command given to the linker.
|
338 |
|
|
|
339 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
340 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
341 |
|
|
|
342 |
|
|
@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
|
343 |
|
|
GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
|
344 |
|
|
However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
|
345 |
|
|
models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
|
346 |
|
|
@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
|
347 |
|
|
blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
|
348 |
|
|
default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
|
349 |
|
|
@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
|
350 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
351 |
|
|
|
352 |
|
|
@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
|
353 |
|
|
Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
|
354 |
|
|
configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
|
355 |
|
|
et al, within sysroot+suffix.
|
356 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
357 |
|
|
|
358 |
|
|
@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
|
359 |
|
|
Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
|
360 |
|
|
GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
|
361 |
|
|
updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
|
362 |
|
|
usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
|
363 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
364 |
|
|
|
365 |
|
|
@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
|
366 |
|
|
Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
|
367 |
|
|
@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
|
368 |
|
|
@code{CC1_SPEC}.
|
369 |
|
|
|
370 |
|
|
The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
|
371 |
|
|
containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
|
372 |
|
|
string constant that provides the specification.
|
373 |
|
|
|
374 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
375 |
|
|
|
376 |
|
|
@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
|
377 |
|
|
related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
|
378 |
|
|
to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
|
379 |
|
|
these definitions.
|
380 |
|
|
|
381 |
|
|
For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
|
382 |
|
|
define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
|
383 |
|
|
used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
|
384 |
|
|
used.
|
385 |
|
|
|
386 |
|
|
The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
|
387 |
|
|
|
388 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
389 |
|
|
#define EXTRA_SPECS \
|
390 |
|
|
@{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
|
391 |
|
|
|
392 |
|
|
#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
|
393 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
394 |
|
|
|
395 |
|
|
The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
|
396 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
397 |
|
|
#undef CPP_SPEC
|
398 |
|
|
#define CPP_SPEC \
|
399 |
|
|
"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
|
400 |
|
|
%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
|
401 |
|
|
%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
|
402 |
|
|
%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
|
403 |
|
|
|
404 |
|
|
#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
|
405 |
|
|
#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
|
406 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
407 |
|
|
|
408 |
|
|
while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
|
409 |
|
|
@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
|
410 |
|
|
|
411 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
412 |
|
|
#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
|
413 |
|
|
#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
|
414 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
415 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
416 |
|
|
|
417 |
|
|
@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
|
418 |
|
|
Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
|
419 |
|
|
@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
|
420 |
|
|
the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
|
421 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
422 |
|
|
|
423 |
|
|
@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
|
424 |
|
|
The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
|
425 |
|
|
By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
|
426 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
427 |
|
|
|
428 |
|
|
@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
|
429 |
|
|
A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
|
430 |
|
|
linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
|
431 |
|
|
change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
|
432 |
|
|
define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
|
433 |
|
|
line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
|
434 |
|
|
the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
|
435 |
|
|
@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
|
436 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
437 |
|
|
|
438 |
|
|
@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
|
439 |
|
|
A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
|
440 |
|
|
directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
|
441 |
|
|
removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
|
442 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
443 |
|
|
|
444 |
|
|
@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
|
445 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
|
446 |
|
|
string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
|
447 |
|
|
target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
|
448 |
|
|
@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
|
449 |
|
|
|
450 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
|
451 |
|
|
the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
|
452 |
|
|
@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
|
453 |
|
|
@xref{Target Fragment}.
|
454 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
455 |
|
|
|
456 |
|
|
@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
|
457 |
|
|
Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
|
458 |
|
|
a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
|
459 |
|
|
indicates an absolute file name.
|
460 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
461 |
|
|
|
462 |
|
|
@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
|
463 |
|
|
If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
|
464 |
|
|
@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
|
465 |
|
|
when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
|
466 |
|
|
compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
|
467 |
|
|
to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
|
468 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
469 |
|
|
|
470 |
|
|
@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
|
471 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
472 |
|
|
standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
|
473 |
|
|
try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
|
474 |
|
|
@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
|
475 |
|
|
is built as a cross compiler.
|
476 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
477 |
|
|
|
478 |
|
|
@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
|
479 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
480 |
|
|
standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
|
481 |
|
|
when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
|
482 |
|
|
@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
|
483 |
|
|
is built as a cross compiler.
|
484 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
485 |
|
|
|
486 |
|
|
@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
|
487 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
488 |
|
|
standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
|
489 |
|
|
default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
|
490 |
|
|
@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
|
491 |
|
|
is built as a cross compiler.
|
492 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
493 |
|
|
|
494 |
|
|
@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
|
495 |
|
|
If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
|
496 |
|
|
standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
|
497 |
|
|
@option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
|
498 |
|
|
compiler.
|
499 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
500 |
|
|
|
501 |
|
|
@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
|
502 |
|
|
If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
|
503 |
|
|
standard prefixes. It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
|
504 |
|
|
used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
|
505 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
506 |
|
|
|
507 |
|
|
@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
|
508 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
|
509 |
|
|
variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
|
510 |
|
|
loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
|
511 |
|
|
initialize the necessary environment variables.
|
512 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
513 |
|
|
|
514 |
|
|
@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
|
515 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
516 |
|
|
standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
|
517 |
|
|
try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
|
518 |
|
|
comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
|
519 |
|
|
|
520 |
|
|
Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
|
521 |
|
|
replacement.
|
522 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
523 |
|
|
|
524 |
|
|
@defmac MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
|
525 |
|
|
Define this macro if you wish to define command-line switches that
|
526 |
|
|
modify the default target name.
|
527 |
|
|
|
528 |
|
|
For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
|
529 |
|
|
part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
|
530 |
|
|
configuration name, if present. The definition should be an initializer
|
531 |
|
|
for an array of structures. Each array element should have three
|
532 |
|
|
elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
|
533 |
|
|
dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
|
534 |
|
|
indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
|
535 |
|
|
to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
|
536 |
|
|
|
537 |
|
|
For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
|
538 |
|
|
configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
|
539 |
|
|
and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
|
540 |
|
|
code
|
541 |
|
|
|
542 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
543 |
|
|
#define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
|
544 |
|
|
@{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
|
545 |
|
|
@{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
|
546 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
547 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
548 |
|
|
|
549 |
|
|
@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
|
550 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
|
551 |
|
|
system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
|
552 |
|
|
directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
|
553 |
|
|
@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
|
554 |
|
|
|
555 |
|
|
Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
|
556 |
|
|
specified.
|
557 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
558 |
|
|
|
559 |
|
|
@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
|
560 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
561 |
|
|
standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
|
562 |
|
|
try when searching for header files.
|
563 |
|
|
|
564 |
|
|
Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
|
565 |
|
|
@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
|
566 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
567 |
|
|
|
568 |
|
|
@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
|
569 |
|
|
The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
|
570 |
|
|
See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
|
571 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
|
572 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
573 |
|
|
|
574 |
|
|
@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
|
575 |
|
|
Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
|
576 |
|
|
for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
|
577 |
|
|
usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
|
578 |
|
|
@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
|
579 |
|
|
@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
|
580 |
|
|
and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
|
581 |
|
|
and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
|
582 |
|
|
@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
|
583 |
|
|
|
584 |
|
|
The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
|
585 |
|
|
Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
|
586 |
|
|
string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
|
587 |
|
|
for C++-only directories,
|
588 |
|
|
and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
|
589 |
|
|
wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
|
590 |
|
|
the array with a null element.
|
591 |
|
|
|
592 |
|
|
The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
|
593 |
|
|
if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
|
594 |
|
|
or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
|
595 |
|
|
operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
|
596 |
|
|
|
597 |
|
|
For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
|
598 |
|
|
|
599 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
600 |
|
|
#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
|
601 |
|
|
@{ \
|
602 |
|
|
@{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
|
603 |
|
|
@{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
|
604 |
|
|
@{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
|
605 |
|
|
@{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
|
606 |
|
|
@{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
|
607 |
|
|
@}
|
608 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
609 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
610 |
|
|
|
611 |
|
|
Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
|
612 |
|
|
|
613 |
|
|
@enumerate
|
614 |
|
|
@item
|
615 |
|
|
Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
|
616 |
|
|
|
617 |
|
|
@item
|
618 |
|
|
The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
|
619 |
|
|
|
620 |
|
|
@item
|
621 |
|
|
The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
|
622 |
|
|
|
623 |
|
|
@item
|
624 |
|
|
The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
|
625 |
|
|
|
626 |
|
|
@item
|
627 |
|
|
@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
|
628 |
|
|
|
629 |
|
|
@item
|
630 |
|
|
The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
|
631 |
|
|
@end enumerate
|
632 |
|
|
|
633 |
|
|
Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
|
634 |
|
|
|
635 |
|
|
@enumerate
|
636 |
|
|
@item
|
637 |
|
|
Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
|
638 |
|
|
|
639 |
|
|
@item
|
640 |
|
|
The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
|
641 |
|
|
|
642 |
|
|
@item
|
643 |
|
|
The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
|
644 |
|
|
(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
|
645 |
|
|
|
646 |
|
|
@item
|
647 |
|
|
The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
|
648 |
|
|
|
649 |
|
|
@item
|
650 |
|
|
@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
|
651 |
|
|
|
652 |
|
|
@item
|
653 |
|
|
The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
|
654 |
|
|
|
655 |
|
|
@item
|
656 |
|
|
The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
|
657 |
|
|
|
658 |
|
|
@item
|
659 |
|
|
The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
|
660 |
|
|
|
661 |
|
|
@item
|
662 |
|
|
@file{/lib/}.
|
663 |
|
|
|
664 |
|
|
@item
|
665 |
|
|
@file{/usr/lib/}.
|
666 |
|
|
@end enumerate
|
667 |
|
|
|
668 |
|
|
@node Run-time Target
|
669 |
|
|
@section Run-time Target Specification
|
670 |
|
|
@cindex run-time target specification
|
671 |
|
|
@cindex predefined macros
|
672 |
|
|
@cindex target specifications
|
673 |
|
|
|
674 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
675 |
|
|
Here are run-time target specifications.
|
676 |
|
|
|
677 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
|
678 |
|
|
This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
|
679 |
|
|
built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target cpu, using
|
680 |
|
|
the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
|
681 |
|
|
@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
|
682 |
|
|
calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
|
683 |
|
|
finished command line option processing your code can use those
|
684 |
|
|
results freely.
|
685 |
|
|
|
686 |
|
|
@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
|
687 |
|
|
command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
|
688 |
|
|
the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
|
689 |
|
|
accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
|
690 |
|
|
|
691 |
|
|
@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
|
692 |
|
|
object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
|
693 |
|
|
@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
|
694 |
|
|
defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
|
695 |
|
|
with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
|
696 |
|
|
only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
|
697 |
|
|
example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
|
698 |
|
|
and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
|
699 |
|
|
@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
|
700 |
|
|
defines only @code{_ABI64}.
|
701 |
|
|
|
702 |
|
|
You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
|
703 |
|
|
@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
|
704 |
|
|
or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
|
705 |
|
|
assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
|
706 |
|
|
macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
|
707 |
|
|
to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
|
708 |
|
|
variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
|
709 |
|
|
@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
|
710 |
|
|
preprocessing.
|
711 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
712 |
|
|
|
713 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
|
714 |
|
|
Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
|
715 |
|
|
and is used for the target operating system instead.
|
716 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
717 |
|
|
|
718 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
|
719 |
|
|
Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
|
720 |
|
|
and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
|
721 |
|
|
macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
|
722 |
|
|
it yourself.
|
723 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
724 |
|
|
|
725 |
|
|
@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
|
726 |
|
|
This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
|
727 |
|
|
any target-specific headers.
|
728 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
729 |
|
|
|
730 |
|
|
@deftypevar {Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
|
731 |
|
|
This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
|
732 |
|
|
Its default setting is 0.
|
733 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
734 |
|
|
|
735 |
|
|
@cindex optional hardware or system features
|
736 |
|
|
@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
|
737 |
|
|
|
738 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
|
739 |
|
|
This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
|
740 |
|
|
target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
|
741 |
|
|
(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
|
742 |
|
|
processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
|
743 |
|
|
definition does nothing but return true.
|
744 |
|
|
|
745 |
|
|
@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
|
746 |
|
|
associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
|
747 |
|
|
the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
|
748 |
|
|
underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
|
749 |
|
|
no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
|
750 |
|
|
(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
|
751 |
|
|
argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
|
752 |
|
|
option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
|
753 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
754 |
|
|
|
755 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_VERSION
|
756 |
|
|
This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
|
757 |
|
|
describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
|
758 |
|
|
description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
|
759 |
|
|
|
760 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
761 |
|
|
#ifdef MOTOROLA
|
762 |
|
|
#define TARGET_VERSION \
|
763 |
|
|
fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
|
764 |
|
|
#else
|
765 |
|
|
#define TARGET_VERSION \
|
766 |
|
|
fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
|
767 |
|
|
#endif
|
768 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
769 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
770 |
|
|
|
771 |
|
|
@defmac OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
|
772 |
|
|
Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
|
773 |
|
|
a particular target machine. You can define a macro
|
774 |
|
|
@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this. This macro, if
|
775 |
|
|
defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
|
776 |
|
|
parsed.
|
777 |
|
|
|
778 |
|
|
Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
|
779 |
|
|
@option{-O}. That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
|
780 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
781 |
|
|
|
782 |
|
|
@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
|
783 |
|
|
This is similar to @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} but is only used in the C
|
784 |
|
|
language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
|
785 |
|
|
used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
|
786 |
|
|
frontends.
|
787 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
788 |
|
|
|
789 |
|
|
@defmac OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
|
790 |
|
|
Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
|
791 |
|
|
various optimization levels. This macro, if defined, is executed once
|
792 |
|
|
just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
|
793 |
|
|
of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
|
794 |
|
|
used as the default values for the other command line options.
|
795 |
|
|
|
796 |
|
|
@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
|
797 |
|
|
specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
|
798 |
|
|
|
799 |
|
|
@var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
|
800 |
|
|
|
801 |
|
|
You should not use this macro to change options that are not
|
802 |
|
|
machine-specific. These should uniformly selected by the same
|
803 |
|
|
optimization level on all supported machines. Use this macro to enable
|
804 |
|
|
machine-specific optimizations.
|
805 |
|
|
|
806 |
|
|
@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
|
807 |
|
|
this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
|
808 |
|
|
generated code.
|
809 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
810 |
|
|
|
811 |
|
|
@defmac CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
|
812 |
|
|
Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
|
813 |
|
|
pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
|
814 |
|
|
@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
|
815 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
816 |
|
|
|
817 |
|
|
@node Per-Function Data
|
818 |
|
|
@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
|
819 |
|
|
@cindex per-function data
|
820 |
|
|
@cindex data structures
|
821 |
|
|
|
822 |
|
|
If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
|
823 |
|
|
provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
|
824 |
|
|
using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
|
825 |
|
|
nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
|
826 |
|
|
when another one comes along.
|
827 |
|
|
|
828 |
|
|
GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
|
829 |
|
|
contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
|
830 |
|
|
structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
|
831 |
|
|
@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
|
832 |
|
|
to their own specific data.
|
833 |
|
|
|
834 |
|
|
If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
|
835 |
|
|
@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
|
836 |
|
|
This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
|
837 |
|
|
@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
|
838 |
|
|
|
839 |
|
|
One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
|
840 |
|
|
RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
|
841 |
|
|
RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
|
842 |
|
|
function, for level 0.
|
843 |
|
|
|
844 |
|
|
Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
|
845 |
|
|
all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
|
846 |
|
|
function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
|
847 |
|
|
stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
|
848 |
|
|
stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
|
849 |
|
|
@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
|
850 |
|
|
the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
|
851 |
|
|
single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
|
852 |
|
|
longer supported.
|
853 |
|
|
|
854 |
|
|
@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
|
855 |
|
|
Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
|
856 |
|
|
is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
|
857 |
|
|
The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
|
858 |
|
|
function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
|
859 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
860 |
|
|
|
861 |
|
|
@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
|
862 |
|
|
If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
|
863 |
|
|
function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
|
864 |
|
|
target to perform any target specific initialization of the
|
865 |
|
|
@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
|
866 |
|
|
used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
|
867 |
|
|
|
868 |
|
|
@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
|
869 |
|
|
Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
|
870 |
|
|
@code{ggc_alloc}, including the structure itself.
|
871 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
872 |
|
|
|
873 |
|
|
@node Storage Layout
|
874 |
|
|
@section Storage Layout
|
875 |
|
|
@cindex storage layout
|
876 |
|
|
|
877 |
|
|
Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
|
878 |
|
|
alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
|
879 |
|
|
expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
|
880 |
|
|
@xref{Run-time Target}.
|
881 |
|
|
|
882 |
|
|
@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
883 |
|
|
Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
|
884 |
|
|
byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
|
885 |
|
|
This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
|
886 |
|
|
bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
|
887 |
|
|
be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
|
888 |
|
|
macro need not be a constant.
|
889 |
|
|
|
890 |
|
|
This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
|
891 |
|
|
bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
|
892 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
893 |
|
|
|
894 |
|
|
@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
895 |
|
|
Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
|
896 |
|
|
word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
|
897 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
898 |
|
|
|
899 |
|
|
@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
900 |
|
|
Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
|
901 |
|
|
most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
|
902 |
|
|
memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
|
903 |
|
|
order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
|
904 |
|
|
macro need not be a constant.
|
905 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
906 |
|
|
|
907 |
|
|
@defmac LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
908 |
|
|
Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
|
909 |
|
|
constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
|
910 |
|
|
used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
|
911 |
|
|
based on preprocessor defines.
|
912 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
913 |
|
|
|
914 |
|
|
@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
915 |
|
|
Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
|
916 |
|
|
@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
|
917 |
|
|
containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
|
918 |
|
|
have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
|
919 |
|
|
|
920 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
|
921 |
|
|
multi-word integers.
|
922 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
923 |
|
|
|
924 |
|
|
@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
|
925 |
|
|
Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
|
926 |
|
|
unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
|
927 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
928 |
|
|
|
929 |
|
|
@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
|
930 |
|
|
Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
|
931 |
|
|
is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
|
932 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
933 |
|
|
|
934 |
|
|
@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
|
935 |
|
|
Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
|
936 |
|
|
@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
|
937 |
|
|
largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
|
938 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
939 |
|
|
|
940 |
|
|
@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
|
941 |
|
|
Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
|
942 |
|
|
register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
|
943 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
944 |
|
|
|
945 |
|
|
@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
|
946 |
|
|
Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
|
947 |
|
|
@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
|
948 |
|
|
smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
|
949 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
950 |
|
|
|
951 |
|
|
@defmac UNITS_PER_SIMD_WORD
|
952 |
|
|
Number of units in the vectors that the vectorizer can produce.
|
953 |
|
|
The default is equal to @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}, because the vectorizer
|
954 |
|
|
can do some transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD}
|
955 |
|
|
hardware.
|
956 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
957 |
|
|
|
958 |
|
|
@defmac POINTER_SIZE
|
959 |
|
|
Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
|
960 |
|
|
width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
|
961 |
|
|
you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
|
962 |
|
|
a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
|
963 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
964 |
|
|
|
965 |
|
|
@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
966 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
|
967 |
|
|
extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
|
968 |
|
|
be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended. If the value
|
969 |
|
|
is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
|
970 |
|
|
extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
|
971 |
|
|
|
972 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
|
973 |
|
|
to the width of @code{Pmode}.
|
974 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
975 |
|
|
|
976 |
|
|
@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
|
977 |
|
|
A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
|
978 |
|
|
is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
|
979 |
|
|
stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
|
980 |
|
|
scalar type.
|
981 |
|
|
|
982 |
|
|
On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
|
983 |
|
|
register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
|
984 |
|
|
@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
|
985 |
|
|
cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
|
986 |
|
|
floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
|
987 |
|
|
counterparts.
|
988 |
|
|
|
989 |
|
|
For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
|
990 |
|
|
However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
|
991 |
|
|
either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
|
992 |
|
|
the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
|
993 |
|
|
sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
|
994 |
|
|
@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
|
995 |
|
|
|
996 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
|
997 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
998 |
|
|
|
999 |
|
|
@defmac PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
|
1000 |
|
|
Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but is applied to outgoing function arguments or
|
1001 |
|
|
function return values, as specified by @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
|
1002 |
|
|
and @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
|
1003 |
|
|
|
1004 |
|
|
The default is @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
|
1005 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1006 |
|
|
|
1007 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS (tree @var{fntype})
|
1008 |
|
|
This target hook should return @code{true} if the promotion described by
|
1009 |
|
|
@code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE} should be done for outgoing function
|
1010 |
|
|
arguments.
|
1011 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1012 |
|
|
|
1013 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN (tree @var{fntype})
|
1014 |
|
|
This target hook should return @code{true} if the promotion described by
|
1015 |
|
|
@code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE} should be done for the return value of
|
1016 |
|
|
functions.
|
1017 |
|
|
|
1018 |
|
|
If this target hook returns @code{true}, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}
|
1019 |
|
|
must perform the same promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE}.
|
1020 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1021 |
|
|
|
1022 |
|
|
@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
|
1023 |
|
|
Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
|
1024 |
|
|
bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
|
1025 |
|
|
regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
|
1026 |
|
|
size of an integer.
|
1027 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1028 |
|
|
|
1029 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
|
1030 |
|
|
Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
|
1031 |
|
|
stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
|
1032 |
|
|
desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
|
1033 |
|
|
if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
|
1034 |
|
|
this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
|
1035 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1036 |
|
|
|
1037 |
|
|
@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
|
1038 |
|
|
Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
|
1039 |
|
|
stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
|
1040 |
|
|
is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
|
1041 |
|
|
macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
|
1042 |
|
|
@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
|
1043 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1044 |
|
|
|
1045 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
|
1046 |
|
|
Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
|
1047 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1048 |
|
|
|
1049 |
|
|
@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
|
1050 |
|
|
Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
|
1051 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1052 |
|
|
|
1053 |
|
|
@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
|
1054 |
|
|
If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
|
1055 |
|
|
object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
|
1056 |
|
|
nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
|
1057 |
|
|
on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
|
1058 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1059 |
|
|
|
1060 |
|
|
@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
|
1061 |
|
|
Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
|
1062 |
|
|
machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
|
1063 |
|
|
structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
|
1064 |
|
|
by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
|
1065 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1066 |
|
|
|
1067 |
|
|
@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
|
1068 |
|
|
An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
|
1069 |
|
|
alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
|
1070 |
|
|
@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
|
1071 |
|
|
alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
|
1072 |
|
|
field alignment has not been set by the
|
1073 |
|
|
@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
|
1074 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1075 |
|
|
|
1076 |
|
|
@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
|
1077 |
|
|
Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
|
1078 |
|
|
Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
|
1079 |
|
|
@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
|
1080 |
|
|
the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
|
1081 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1082 |
|
|
|
1083 |
|
|
@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
|
1084 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
|
1085 |
|
|
the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
|
1086 |
|
|
the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
|
1087 |
|
|
macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
|
1088 |
|
|
|
1089 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
|
1090 |
|
|
|
1091 |
|
|
@findex strcpy
|
1092 |
|
|
One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
|
1093 |
|
|
make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
|
1094 |
|
|
arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
|
1095 |
|
|
constants to character arrays can be done inline.
|
1096 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1097 |
|
|
|
1098 |
|
|
@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
|
1099 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
|
1100 |
|
|
that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
|
1101 |
|
|
@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
|
1102 |
|
|
have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
|
1103 |
|
|
align the object.
|
1104 |
|
|
|
1105 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
|
1106 |
|
|
|
1107 |
|
|
The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
|
1108 |
|
|
constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
|
1109 |
|
|
constants can be done inline.
|
1110 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1111 |
|
|
|
1112 |
|
|
@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
|
1113 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
|
1114 |
|
|
the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
|
1115 |
|
|
the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
|
1116 |
|
|
macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
|
1117 |
|
|
|
1118 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
|
1119 |
|
|
|
1120 |
|
|
One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
|
1121 |
|
|
make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
|
1122 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1123 |
|
|
|
1124 |
|
|
@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
|
1125 |
|
|
Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
|
1126 |
|
|
empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
|
1127 |
|
|
|
1128 |
|
|
If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
|
1129 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1130 |
|
|
|
1131 |
|
|
@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
|
1132 |
|
|
Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
|
1133 |
|
|
Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
|
1134 |
|
|
|
1135 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
|
1136 |
|
|
@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
|
1137 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1138 |
|
|
|
1139 |
|
|
@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
|
1140 |
|
|
Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
|
1141 |
|
|
if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
|
1142 |
|
|
go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
|
1143 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1144 |
|
|
|
1145 |
|
|
@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
|
1146 |
|
|
Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
|
1147 |
|
|
alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
|
1148 |
|
|
|
1149 |
|
|
The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
|
1150 |
|
|
@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
|
1151 |
|
|
structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
|
1152 |
|
|
that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
|
1153 |
|
|
that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
|
1154 |
|
|
|
1155 |
|
|
Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
|
1156 |
|
|
@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
|
1157 |
|
|
four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
|
1158 |
|
|
not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
|
1159 |
|
|
|
1160 |
|
|
An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
|
1161 |
|
|
structure.
|
1162 |
|
|
|
1163 |
|
|
If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
|
1164 |
|
|
a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
|
1165 |
|
|
|
1166 |
|
|
Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
|
1167 |
|
|
bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
|
1168 |
|
|
support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
|
1169 |
|
|
@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
|
1170 |
|
|
|
1171 |
|
|
The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
|
1172 |
|
|
@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
|
1173 |
|
|
Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
|
1174 |
|
|
|
1175 |
|
|
Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
|
1176 |
|
|
@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
|
1177 |
|
|
@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
|
1178 |
|
|
|
1179 |
|
|
If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
|
1180 |
|
|
bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
|
1181 |
|
|
what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
|
1182 |
|
|
|
1183 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
1184 |
|
|
struct foo1
|
1185 |
|
|
@{
|
1186 |
|
|
char x;
|
1187 |
|
|
char :0;
|
1188 |
|
|
char y;
|
1189 |
|
|
@};
|
1190 |
|
|
|
1191 |
|
|
struct foo2
|
1192 |
|
|
@{
|
1193 |
|
|
char x;
|
1194 |
|
|
int :0;
|
1195 |
|
|
char y;
|
1196 |
|
|
@};
|
1197 |
|
|
|
1198 |
|
|
main ()
|
1199 |
|
|
@{
|
1200 |
|
|
printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
|
1201 |
|
|
sizeof (struct foo1));
|
1202 |
|
|
printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
|
1203 |
|
|
sizeof (struct foo2));
|
1204 |
|
|
exit (0);
|
1205 |
|
|
@}
|
1206 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1207 |
|
|
|
1208 |
|
|
If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
|
1209 |
|
|
get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
|
1210 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1211 |
|
|
|
1212 |
|
|
@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
|
1213 |
|
|
Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
|
1214 |
|
|
to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
|
1215 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1216 |
|
|
|
1217 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELDS (void)
|
1218 |
|
|
When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
|
1219 |
|
|
whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
|
1220 |
|
|
structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
|
1221 |
|
|
the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
|
1222 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1223 |
|
|
|
1224 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELDS (void)
|
1225 |
|
|
This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
|
1226 |
|
|
should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
|
1227 |
|
|
these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
|
1228 |
|
|
|
1229 |
|
|
The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
|
1230 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1231 |
|
|
|
1232 |
|
|
@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
|
1233 |
|
|
Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
|
1234 |
|
|
@code{BLKMODE}.
|
1235 |
|
|
|
1236 |
|
|
If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
|
1237 |
|
|
mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
|
1238 |
|
|
case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
|
1239 |
|
|
retain the field's mode.
|
1240 |
|
|
|
1241 |
|
|
Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
|
1242 |
|
|
of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
|
1243 |
|
|
field from being accessed in an integer mode.
|
1244 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1245 |
|
|
|
1246 |
|
|
@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
|
1247 |
|
|
Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
|
1248 |
|
|
by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
|
1249 |
|
|
way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
|
1250 |
|
|
@var{specified}.
|
1251 |
|
|
|
1252 |
|
|
The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
|
1253 |
|
|
the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
|
1254 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1255 |
|
|
|
1256 |
|
|
@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
|
1257 |
|
|
An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
|
1258 |
|
|
machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
|
1259 |
|
|
this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
|
1260 |
|
|
appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
|
1261 |
|
|
(DImode)} is assumed.
|
1262 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1263 |
|
|
|
1264 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
|
1265 |
|
|
If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
|
1266 |
|
|
specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
|
1267 |
|
|
@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
|
1268 |
|
|
@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
|
1269 |
|
|
@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
|
1270 |
|
|
having its mode specified.
|
1271 |
|
|
|
1272 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
|
1273 |
|
|
would most commonly define this macro if the
|
1274 |
|
|
@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
|
1275 |
|
|
64-bit mode.
|
1276 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1277 |
|
|
|
1278 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
|
1279 |
|
|
If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
|
1280 |
|
|
specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
|
1281 |
|
|
@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
|
1282 |
|
|
|
1283 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
|
1284 |
|
|
You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
|
1285 |
|
|
pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
|
1286 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1287 |
|
|
|
1288 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
1289 |
|
|
A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
|
1290 |
|
|
There are four defined values:
|
1291 |
|
|
|
1292 |
|
|
@ftable @code
|
1293 |
|
|
@item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
1294 |
|
|
This code indicates IEEE floating point. It is the default; there is no
|
1295 |
|
|
need to define @code{TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT} when the format is IEEE@.
|
1296 |
|
|
|
1297 |
|
|
@item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
1298 |
|
|
This code indicates the ``F float'' (for @code{float}) and ``D float''
|
1299 |
|
|
or ``G float'' formats (for @code{double}) used on the VAX and PDP-11@.
|
1300 |
|
|
|
1301 |
|
|
@item IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
1302 |
|
|
This code indicates the format used on the IBM System/370.
|
1303 |
|
|
|
1304 |
|
|
@item C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
1305 |
|
|
This code indicates the format used on the TMS320C3x/C4x.
|
1306 |
|
|
@end ftable
|
1307 |
|
|
|
1308 |
|
|
If your target uses a floating point format other than these, you must
|
1309 |
|
|
define a new @var{name}_FLOAT_FORMAT code for it, and add support for
|
1310 |
|
|
it to @file{real.c}.
|
1311 |
|
|
|
1312 |
|
|
The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
|
1313 |
|
|
memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}.
|
1314 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1315 |
|
|
|
1316 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_HAS_NANS (@var{mode})
|
1317 |
|
|
When defined, this macro should be true if @var{mode} has a NaN
|
1318 |
|
|
representation. The compiler assumes that NaNs are not equal to
|
1319 |
|
|
anything (including themselves) and that addition, subtraction,
|
1320 |
|
|
multiplication and division all return NaNs when one operand is
|
1321 |
|
|
NaN@.
|
1322 |
|
|
|
1323 |
|
|
By default, this macro is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
|
1324 |
|
|
mode and the target floating-point format is IEEE@.
|
1325 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1326 |
|
|
|
1327 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_HAS_INFINITIES (@var{mode})
|
1328 |
|
|
This macro should be true if @var{mode} can represent infinity. At
|
1329 |
|
|
present, the compiler uses this macro to decide whether @samp{x - x}
|
1330 |
|
|
is always defined. By default, the macro is true when @var{mode}
|
1331 |
|
|
is a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
|
1332 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1333 |
|
|
|
1334 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_HAS_SIGNED_ZEROS (@var{mode})
|
1335 |
|
|
True if @var{mode} distinguishes between positive and negative zero.
|
1336 |
|
|
The rules are expected to follow the IEEE standard:
|
1337 |
|
|
|
1338 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
1339 |
|
|
@item
|
1340 |
|
|
@samp{x + x} has the same sign as @samp{x}.
|
1341 |
|
|
|
1342 |
|
|
@item
|
1343 |
|
|
If the sum of two values with opposite sign is zero, the result is
|
1344 |
|
|
positive for all rounding modes expect towards @minus{}infinity, for
|
1345 |
|
|
which it is negative.
|
1346 |
|
|
|
1347 |
|
|
@item
|
1348 |
|
|
The sign of a product or quotient is negative when exactly one
|
1349 |
|
|
of the operands is negative.
|
1350 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
1351 |
|
|
|
1352 |
|
|
The default definition is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
|
1353 |
|
|
mode and the target format is IEEE@.
|
1354 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1355 |
|
|
|
1356 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING (@var{mode})
|
1357 |
|
|
If defined, this macro should be true for @var{mode} if it has at
|
1358 |
|
|
least one rounding mode in which @samp{x} and @samp{-x} can be
|
1359 |
|
|
rounded to numbers of different magnitude. Two such modes are
|
1360 |
|
|
towards @minus{}infinity and towards +infinity.
|
1361 |
|
|
|
1362 |
|
|
The default definition of this macro is true if @var{mode} is
|
1363 |
|
|
a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
|
1364 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1365 |
|
|
|
1366 |
|
|
@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
|
1367 |
|
|
If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
|
1368 |
|
|
mode is towards zero. A true value has the following effects:
|
1369 |
|
|
|
1370 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
1371 |
|
|
@item
|
1372 |
|
|
@code{MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING} will be false for all modes.
|
1373 |
|
|
|
1374 |
|
|
@item
|
1375 |
|
|
@file{libgcc.a}'s floating-point emulator will round towards zero
|
1376 |
|
|
rather than towards nearest.
|
1377 |
|
|
|
1378 |
|
|
@item
|
1379 |
|
|
The compiler's floating-point emulator will round towards zero after
|
1380 |
|
|
doing arithmetic, and when converting from the internal float format to
|
1381 |
|
|
the target format.
|
1382 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
1383 |
|
|
|
1384 |
|
|
The macro does not affect the parsing of string literals. When the
|
1385 |
|
|
primary rounding mode is towards zero, library functions like
|
1386 |
|
|
@code{strtod} might still round towards nearest, and the compiler's
|
1387 |
|
|
parser should behave like the target's @code{strtod} where possible.
|
1388 |
|
|
|
1389 |
|
|
Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
|
1390 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1391 |
|
|
|
1392 |
|
|
@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
|
1393 |
|
|
This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
|
1394 |
|
|
bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
|
1395 |
|
|
exponent for normal numbers instead.
|
1396 |
|
|
|
1397 |
|
|
Defining this macro to true for @var{size} causes @code{MODE_HAS_NANS}
|
1398 |
|
|
and @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES} to be false for @var{size}-bit modes.
|
1399 |
|
|
It also affects the way @file{libgcc.a} and @file{real.c} emulate
|
1400 |
|
|
floating-point arithmetic.
|
1401 |
|
|
|
1402 |
|
|
The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
|
1403 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1404 |
|
|
|
1405 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_OPAQUE_P (tree @var{type})
|
1406 |
|
|
This target hook should return @code{true} a vector is opaque. That
|
1407 |
|
|
is, if no cast is needed when copying a vector value of type
|
1408 |
|
|
@var{type} into another vector lvalue of the same size. Vector opaque
|
1409 |
|
|
types cannot be initialized. The default is that there are no such
|
1410 |
|
|
types.
|
1411 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1412 |
|
|
|
1413 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (tree @var{record_type})
|
1414 |
|
|
This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
|
1415 |
|
|
@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
|
1416 |
|
|
Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
|
1417 |
|
|
unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
|
1418 |
|
|
different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
|
1419 |
|
|
alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
|
1420 |
|
|
bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
|
1421 |
|
|
the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
|
1422 |
|
|
(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
|
1423 |
|
|
another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
|
1424 |
|
|
other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
|
1425 |
|
|
|
1426 |
|
|
When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
|
1427 |
|
|
of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
|
1428 |
|
|
bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
|
1429 |
|
|
and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
|
1430 |
|
|
chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
|
1431 |
|
|
size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
|
1432 |
|
|
alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
|
1433 |
|
|
|
1434 |
|
|
If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
|
1435 |
|
|
the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
|
1436 |
|
|
used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
|
1437 |
|
|
precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
|
1438 |
|
|
may affect its placement.
|
1439 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1440 |
|
|
|
1441 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {bool} TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
|
1442 |
|
|
Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
|
1443 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1444 |
|
|
|
1445 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_FUNDAMENTAL_TYPE (tree @var{type})
|
1446 |
|
|
If your target defines any fundamental types, define this hook to
|
1447 |
|
|
return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
|
1448 |
|
|
mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure
|
1449 |
|
|
representing the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees
|
1450 |
|
|
which are not target-specific fundamental types; it should return
|
1451 |
|
|
@code{NULL} for all such types, as well as arguments it does not
|
1452 |
|
|
recognize. If the return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to
|
1453 |
|
|
a statically-allocated string constant.
|
1454 |
|
|
|
1455 |
|
|
Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
|
1456 |
|
|
qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
|
1457 |
|
|
fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
|
1458 |
|
|
is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
|
1459 |
|
|
length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
|
1460 |
|
|
ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
|
1461 |
|
|
@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
|
1462 |
|
|
@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
|
1463 |
|
|
code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
|
1464 |
|
|
@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
|
1465 |
|
|
codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
|
1466 |
|
|
spaces in your string.
|
1467 |
|
|
|
1468 |
|
|
The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
|
1469 |
|
|
appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
|
1470 |
|
|
types.
|
1471 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1472 |
|
|
|
1473 |
|
|
@node Type Layout
|
1474 |
|
|
@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
|
1475 |
|
|
|
1476 |
|
|
These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
|
1477 |
|
|
basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
|
1478 |
|
|
the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
|
1479 |
|
|
languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
|
1480 |
|
|
|
1481 |
|
|
@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
|
1482 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
|
1483 |
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
|
1484 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1485 |
|
|
|
1486 |
|
|
@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
|
1487 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
|
1488 |
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
|
1489 |
|
|
(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
|
1490 |
|
|
unit.)
|
1491 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1492 |
|
|
|
1493 |
|
|
@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
1494 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
|
1495 |
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
|
1496 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1497 |
|
|
|
1498 |
|
|
@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
1499 |
|
|
On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
|
1500 |
|
|
@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
|
1501 |
|
|
that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
|
1502 |
|
|
the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
|
1503 |
|
|
value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
|
1504 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1505 |
|
|
|
1506 |
|
|
@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
1507 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
|
1508 |
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
|
1509 |
|
|
words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
|
1510 |
|
|
macro must be at least 64.
|
1511 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1512 |
|
|
|
1513 |
|
|
@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
1514 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
|
1515 |
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
|
1516 |
|
|
@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
|
1517 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1518 |
|
|
|
1519 |
|
|
@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
|
1520 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
|
1521 |
|
|
C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
|
1522 |
|
|
this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
|
1523 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1524 |
|
|
|
1525 |
|
|
@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
|
1526 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
|
1527 |
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
|
1528 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1529 |
|
|
|
1530 |
|
|
@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
|
1531 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
|
1532 |
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
|
1533 |
|
|
words.
|
1534 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1535 |
|
|
|
1536 |
|
|
@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
|
1537 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
|
1538 |
|
|
the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
|
1539 |
|
|
words.
|
1540 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1541 |
|
|
|
1542 |
|
|
@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
|
1543 |
|
|
Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
|
1544 |
|
|
if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
|
1545 |
|
|
@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
|
1546 |
|
|
default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
|
1547 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1548 |
|
|
|
1549 |
|
|
@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
|
1550 |
|
|
Define this macro if neither @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
|
1551 |
|
|
@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
|
1552 |
|
|
@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
|
1553 |
|
|
anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
|
1554 |
|
|
or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
|
1555 |
|
|
otherwise it is 0.
|
1556 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1557 |
|
|
|
1558 |
|
|
@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
|
1559 |
|
|
Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
|
1560 |
|
|
@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
|
1561 |
|
|
anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
|
1562 |
|
|
is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
|
1563 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1564 |
|
|
|
1565 |
|
|
@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
|
1566 |
|
|
Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
|
1567 |
|
|
@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
|
1568 |
|
|
anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
|
1569 |
|
|
is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
|
1570 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1571 |
|
|
|
1572 |
|
|
@defmac SF_SIZE
|
1573 |
|
|
@defmacx DF_SIZE
|
1574 |
|
|
@defmacx XF_SIZE
|
1575 |
|
|
@defmacx TF_SIZE
|
1576 |
|
|
Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
|
1577 |
|
|
@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
|
1578 |
|
|
if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
|
1579 |
|
|
@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
|
1580 |
|
|
for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
|
1581 |
|
|
@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
|
1582 |
|
|
@code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
|
1583 |
|
|
@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
|
1584 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1585 |
|
|
|
1586 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
|
1587 |
|
|
A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
|
1588 |
|
|
assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
|
1589 |
|
|
default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
|
1590 |
|
|
@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
|
1591 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1592 |
|
|
|
1593 |
|
|
@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
|
1594 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
|
1595 |
|
|
supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
|
1596 |
|
|
value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
|
1597 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
|
1598 |
|
|
is the default.
|
1599 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1600 |
|
|
|
1601 |
|
|
@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
|
1602 |
|
|
An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
|
1603 |
|
|
@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
|
1604 |
|
|
always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
|
1605 |
|
|
and @option{-funsigned-char}.
|
1606 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1607 |
|
|
|
1608 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
|
1609 |
|
|
This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
|
1610 |
|
|
@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
|
1611 |
|
|
of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
|
1612 |
|
|
@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
|
1613 |
|
|
|
1614 |
|
|
The default is to return false.
|
1615 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
1616 |
|
|
|
1617 |
|
|
@defmac SIZE_TYPE
|
1618 |
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
|
1619 |
|
|
for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
|
1620 |
|
|
contents of the string.
|
1621 |
|
|
|
1622 |
|
|
The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
|
1623 |
|
|
spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
|
1624 |
|
|
appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
|
1625 |
|
|
of the data type names defined in the function
|
1626 |
|
|
@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
|
1627 |
|
|
omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
|
1628 |
|
|
crash on startup.
|
1629 |
|
|
|
1630 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
|
1631 |
|
|
int"}.
|
1632 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1633 |
|
|
|
1634 |
|
|
@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
|
1635 |
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
|
1636 |
|
|
for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
|
1637 |
|
|
@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
|
1638 |
|
|
@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
|
1639 |
|
|
|
1640 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
|
1641 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1642 |
|
|
|
1643 |
|
|
@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
|
1644 |
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
|
1645 |
|
|
for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
|
1646 |
|
|
the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
|
1647 |
|
|
information.
|
1648 |
|
|
|
1649 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
|
1650 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1651 |
|
|
|
1652 |
|
|
@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
1653 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
|
1654 |
|
|
characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
|
1655 |
|
|
@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
|
1656 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1657 |
|
|
|
1658 |
|
|
@defmac WINT_TYPE
|
1659 |
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
|
1660 |
|
|
use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
|
1661 |
|
|
@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
|
1662 |
|
|
contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
|
1663 |
|
|
information.
|
1664 |
|
|
|
1665 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
|
1666 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1667 |
|
|
|
1668 |
|
|
@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
|
1669 |
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
|
1670 |
|
|
can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
|
1671 |
|
|
The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
|
1672 |
|
|
string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
|
1673 |
|
|
|
1674 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
|
1675 |
|
|
@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
|
1676 |
|
|
much precision as @code{long long int}.
|
1677 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1678 |
|
|
|
1679 |
|
|
@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
|
1680 |
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
|
1681 |
|
|
can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
|
1682 |
|
|
type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
|
1683 |
|
|
of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
|
1684 |
|
|
|
1685 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
|
1686 |
|
|
@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
|
1687 |
|
|
unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
|
1688 |
|
|
int}.
|
1689 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1690 |
|
|
|
1691 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
|
1692 |
|
|
The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
|
1693 |
|
|
that looks like:
|
1694 |
|
|
|
1695 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
1696 |
|
|
struct @{
|
1697 |
|
|
union @{
|
1698 |
|
|
void (*fn)();
|
1699 |
|
|
ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
|
1700 |
|
|
@};
|
1701 |
|
|
ptrdiff_t delta;
|
1702 |
|
|
@};
|
1703 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1704 |
|
|
|
1705 |
|
|
@noindent
|
1706 |
|
|
The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
|
1707 |
|
|
will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
|
1708 |
|
|
Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
|
1709 |
|
|
always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
|
1710 |
|
|
distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
|
1711 |
|
|
platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
|
1712 |
|
|
that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
|
1713 |
|
|
the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
|
1714 |
|
|
|
1715 |
|
|
GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
|
1716 |
|
|
this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
|
1717 |
|
|
However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
|
1718 |
|
|
set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
|
1719 |
|
|
bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
|
1720 |
|
|
address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
|
1721 |
|
|
architecture, you should define this macro to
|
1722 |
|
|
@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
|
1723 |
|
|
|
1724 |
|
|
In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
|
1725 |
|
|
in which function addresses are always even, according to
|
1726 |
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
|
1727 |
|
|
@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
|
1728 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1729 |
|
|
|
1730 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
|
1731 |
|
|
Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
|
1732 |
|
|
macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
|
1733 |
|
|
instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
|
1734 |
|
|
function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
|
1735 |
|
|
data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
|
1736 |
|
|
pointer to which the function's data is relative.
|
1737 |
|
|
|
1738 |
|
|
If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
|
1739 |
|
|
of words that the function descriptor occupies.
|
1740 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1741 |
|
|
|
1742 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
|
1743 |
|
|
By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
|
1744 |
|
|
is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
|
1745 |
|
|
the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
|
1746 |
|
|
when special alignment is necessary. */
|
1747 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1748 |
|
|
|
1749 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
|
1750 |
|
|
There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
|
1751 |
|
|
zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
|
1752 |
|
|
specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
|
1753 |
|
|
of words in each data entry.
|
1754 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1755 |
|
|
|
1756 |
|
|
@node Registers
|
1757 |
|
|
@section Register Usage
|
1758 |
|
|
@cindex register usage
|
1759 |
|
|
|
1760 |
|
|
This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
|
1761 |
|
|
has, and how (in general) they can be used.
|
1762 |
|
|
|
1763 |
|
|
The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
|
1764 |
|
|
done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
|
1765 |
|
|
on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
|
1766 |
|
|
For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
|
1767 |
|
|
For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
|
1768 |
|
|
|
1769 |
|
|
@menu
|
1770 |
|
|
* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
|
1771 |
|
|
* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
|
1772 |
|
|
* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
|
1773 |
|
|
* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
|
1774 |
|
|
* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
|
1775 |
|
|
@end menu
|
1776 |
|
|
|
1777 |
|
|
@node Register Basics
|
1778 |
|
|
@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
|
1779 |
|
|
|
1780 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
1781 |
|
|
Registers have various characteristics.
|
1782 |
|
|
|
1783 |
|
|
@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
1784 |
|
|
Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
|
1785 |
|
|
numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
|
1786 |
|
|
pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
|
1787 |
|
|
@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
|
1788 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1789 |
|
|
|
1790 |
|
|
@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
|
1791 |
|
|
@cindex fixed register
|
1792 |
|
|
An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
|
1793 |
|
|
all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
|
1794 |
|
|
general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
|
1795 |
|
|
pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
|
1796 |
|
|
register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
|
1797 |
|
|
machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
|
1798 |
|
|
and any other numbered register with a standard use.
|
1799 |
|
|
|
1800 |
|
|
This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
|
1801 |
|
|
commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
|
1802 |
|
|
register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
|
1803 |
|
|
|
1804 |
|
|
The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
|
1805 |
|
|
the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
|
1806 |
|
|
by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
|
1807 |
|
|
the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
|
1808 |
|
|
@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
|
1809 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1810 |
|
|
|
1811 |
|
|
@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
|
1812 |
|
|
@cindex call-used register
|
1813 |
|
|
@cindex call-clobbered register
|
1814 |
|
|
@cindex call-saved register
|
1815 |
|
|
Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
|
1816 |
|
|
clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
|
1817 |
|
|
registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
|
1818 |
|
|
available for general allocation of values that must live across
|
1819 |
|
|
function calls.
|
1820 |
|
|
|
1821 |
|
|
If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
|
1822 |
|
|
automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
|
1823 |
|
|
exit, if the register is used within the function.
|
1824 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1825 |
|
|
|
1826 |
|
|
@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
|
1827 |
|
|
@cindex call-used register
|
1828 |
|
|
@cindex call-clobbered register
|
1829 |
|
|
@cindex call-saved register
|
1830 |
|
|
Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
|
1831 |
|
|
that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
|
1832 |
|
|
(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
|
1833 |
|
|
This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
|
1834 |
|
|
of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
|
1835 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1836 |
|
|
|
1837 |
|
|
@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
|
1838 |
|
|
@cindex call-used register
|
1839 |
|
|
@cindex call-clobbered register
|
1840 |
|
|
@cindex call-saved register
|
1841 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
|
1842 |
|
|
value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
|
1843 |
|
|
call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
|
1844 |
|
|
macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
|
1845 |
|
|
preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
|
1846 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1847 |
|
|
|
1848 |
|
|
@findex fixed_regs
|
1849 |
|
|
@findex call_used_regs
|
1850 |
|
|
@findex global_regs
|
1851 |
|
|
@findex reg_names
|
1852 |
|
|
@findex reg_class_contents
|
1853 |
|
|
@defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
|
1854 |
|
|
Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
|
1855 |
|
|
@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
|
1856 |
|
|
@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
|
1857 |
|
|
any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
|
1858 |
|
|
of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
|
1859 |
|
|
@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
|
1860 |
|
|
@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
|
1861 |
|
|
called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
|
1862 |
|
|
@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
|
1863 |
|
|
from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
|
1864 |
|
|
@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
|
1865 |
|
|
@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
|
1866 |
|
|
@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
|
1867 |
|
|
command options have been applied.
|
1868 |
|
|
|
1869 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
|
1870 |
|
|
|
1871 |
|
|
@cindex disabling certain registers
|
1872 |
|
|
@cindex controlling register usage
|
1873 |
|
|
If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
|
1874 |
|
|
flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
|
1875 |
|
|
@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
|
1876 |
|
|
registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
|
1877 |
|
|
the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
|
1878 |
|
|
to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
|
1879 |
|
|
is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
|
1880 |
|
|
|
1881 |
|
|
(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
|
1882 |
|
|
of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
|
1883 |
|
|
controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
|
1884 |
|
|
these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
|
1885 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1886 |
|
|
|
1887 |
|
|
@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
|
1888 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
|
1889 |
|
|
expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
|
1890 |
|
|
corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
|
1891 |
|
|
function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
|
1892 |
|
|
outbound register.
|
1893 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1894 |
|
|
|
1895 |
|
|
@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
|
1896 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
|
1897 |
|
|
expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
|
1898 |
|
|
corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
|
1899 |
|
|
function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
|
1900 |
|
|
register.
|
1901 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1902 |
|
|
|
1903 |
|
|
@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
|
1904 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
|
1905 |
|
|
expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
|
1906 |
|
|
register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
|
1907 |
|
|
need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
|
1908 |
|
|
gotos.
|
1909 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1910 |
|
|
|
1911 |
|
|
@defmac PC_REGNUM
|
1912 |
|
|
If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
|
1913 |
|
|
register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
|
1914 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1915 |
|
|
|
1916 |
|
|
@node Allocation Order
|
1917 |
|
|
@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
|
1918 |
|
|
@cindex order of register allocation
|
1919 |
|
|
@cindex register allocation order
|
1920 |
|
|
|
1921 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
1922 |
|
|
Registers are allocated in order.
|
1923 |
|
|
|
1924 |
|
|
@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
|
1925 |
|
|
If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
|
1926 |
|
|
numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
|
1927 |
|
|
to use them (from most preferred to least).
|
1928 |
|
|
|
1929 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
|
1930 |
|
|
(all else being equal).
|
1931 |
|
|
|
1932 |
|
|
One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
|
1933 |
|
|
registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
|
1934 |
|
|
instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
|
1935 |
|
|
machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
|
1936 |
|
|
the highest numbered allocable register first.
|
1937 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1938 |
|
|
|
1939 |
|
|
@defmac ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
|
1940 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
|
1941 |
|
|
hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
|
1942 |
|
|
|
1943 |
|
|
Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
|
1944 |
|
|
Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
|
1945 |
|
|
register; and so on.
|
1946 |
|
|
|
1947 |
|
|
The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
|
1948 |
|
|
@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
|
1949 |
|
|
|
1950 |
|
|
On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
|
1951 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1952 |
|
|
|
1953 |
|
|
@node Values in Registers
|
1954 |
|
|
@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
|
1955 |
|
|
|
1956 |
|
|
This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
|
1957 |
|
|
(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
|
1958 |
|
|
consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
|
1959 |
|
|
|
1960 |
|
|
@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
|
1961 |
|
|
A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
|
1962 |
|
|
at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
|
1963 |
|
|
@var{mode}.
|
1964 |
|
|
|
1965 |
|
|
On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
|
1966 |
|
|
definition of this macro is
|
1967 |
|
|
|
1968 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
1969 |
|
|
#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
|
1970 |
|
|
((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
|
1971 |
|
|
/ UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
1972 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1973 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1974 |
|
|
|
1975 |
|
|
@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
|
1976 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
|
1977 |
|
|
in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
|
1978 |
|
|
in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
|
1979 |
|
|
multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
|
1980 |
|
|
this mode by the number of registers returned by
|
1981 |
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
|
1982 |
|
|
|
1983 |
|
|
For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
|
1984 |
|
|
registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
|
1985 |
|
|
nonzero.
|
1986 |
|
|
|
1987 |
|
|
This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
|
1988 |
|
|
@code{subreg_regno_offset} and @code{subreg_offset_representable_p}
|
1989 |
|
|
would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
|
1990 |
|
|
represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
|
1991 |
|
|
@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
|
1992 |
|
|
registers and so not be representable.
|
1993 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
1994 |
|
|
|
1995 |
|
|
@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
|
1996 |
|
|
For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
|
1997 |
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
|
1998 |
|
|
returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
|
1999 |
|
|
including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
|
2000 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2001 |
|
|
|
2002 |
|
|
@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
|
2003 |
|
|
Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
|
2004 |
|
|
of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
|
2005 |
|
|
should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
|
2006 |
|
|
used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
|
2007 |
|
|
happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
|
2008 |
|
|
floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
|
2009 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2010 |
|
|
|
2011 |
|
|
@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
|
2012 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
|
2013 |
|
|
of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
|
2014 |
|
|
registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
|
2015 |
|
|
are equivalent, a suitable definition is
|
2016 |
|
|
|
2017 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
2018 |
|
|
#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
|
2019 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
2020 |
|
|
|
2021 |
|
|
You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
|
2022 |
|
|
because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
|
2023 |
|
|
|
2024 |
|
|
@cindex register pairs
|
2025 |
|
|
On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
|
2026 |
|
|
register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
|
2027 |
|
|
odd register numbers for such modes.
|
2028 |
|
|
|
2029 |
|
|
The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
|
2030 |
|
|
@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
|
2031 |
|
|
register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
|
2032 |
|
|
value into the register and back out not alter it.
|
2033 |
|
|
|
2034 |
|
|
Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
|
2035 |
|
|
all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
|
2036 |
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
|
2037 |
|
|
you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
|
2038 |
|
|
is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
|
2039 |
|
|
and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
|
2040 |
|
|
to be tieable.
|
2041 |
|
|
|
2042 |
|
|
Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
|
2043 |
|
|
Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
|
2044 |
|
|
in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
|
2045 |
|
|
can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
|
2046 |
|
|
mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
|
2047 |
|
|
registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
|
2048 |
|
|
|
2049 |
|
|
On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
|
2050 |
|
|
modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
|
2051 |
|
|
registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
|
2052 |
|
|
non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
|
2053 |
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
|
2054 |
|
|
floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
|
2055 |
|
|
normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
|
2056 |
|
|
unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
|
2057 |
|
|
register, so you can define this macro to say so.
|
2058 |
|
|
|
2059 |
|
|
The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
|
2060 |
|
|
they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
|
2061 |
|
|
instructions. However, this is of no concern to
|
2062 |
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
|
2063 |
|
|
constraints for those instructions.
|
2064 |
|
|
|
2065 |
|
|
On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
|
2066 |
|
|
so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
|
2067 |
|
|
register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
|
2068 |
|
|
floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
|
2069 |
|
|
be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
|
2070 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2071 |
|
|
|
2072 |
|
|
@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
|
2073 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
|
2074 |
|
|
@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
|
2075 |
|
|
|
2076 |
|
|
One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
|
2077 |
|
|
another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
|
2078 |
|
|
handler.
|
2079 |
|
|
|
2080 |
|
|
The default is always nonzero.
|
2081 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2082 |
|
|
|
2083 |
|
|
@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
|
2084 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
|
2085 |
|
|
@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
|
2086 |
|
|
|
2087 |
|
|
If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
|
2088 |
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
|
2089 |
|
|
any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
|
2090 |
|
|
should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
|
2091 |
|
|
this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
|
2092 |
|
|
accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
|
2093 |
|
|
|
2094 |
|
|
You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
|
2095 |
|
|
possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
|
2096 |
|
|
allocation.
|
2097 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2098 |
|
|
|
2099 |
|
|
@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
|
2100 |
|
|
Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
|
2101 |
|
|
registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
|
2102 |
|
|
@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
|
2103 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2104 |
|
|
|
2105 |
|
|
@node Leaf Functions
|
2106 |
|
|
@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
|
2107 |
|
|
|
2108 |
|
|
@cindex leaf functions
|
2109 |
|
|
@cindex functions, leaf
|
2110 |
|
|
On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
|
2111 |
|
|
more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
|
2112 |
|
|
means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
|
2113 |
|
|
are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
|
2114 |
|
|
normally arrive.
|
2115 |
|
|
|
2116 |
|
|
The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
|
2117 |
|
|
other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
|
2118 |
|
|
registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
|
2119 |
|
|
function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
|
2120 |
|
|
handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
|
2121 |
|
|
functions''.
|
2122 |
|
|
|
2123 |
|
|
GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
|
2124 |
|
|
suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
|
2125 |
|
|
registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
|
2126 |
|
|
accomplish this.
|
2127 |
|
|
|
2128 |
|
|
@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
|
2129 |
|
|
Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
|
2130 |
|
|
contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
|
2131 |
|
|
function treatment.
|
2132 |
|
|
|
2133 |
|
|
If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
|
2134 |
|
|
registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
|
2135 |
|
|
GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
|
2136 |
|
|
used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
|
2137 |
|
|
in this vector.
|
2138 |
|
|
|
2139 |
|
|
Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
|
2140 |
|
|
the treatment of leaf functions.
|
2141 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2142 |
|
|
|
2143 |
|
|
@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
|
2144 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
|
2145 |
|
|
should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
|
2146 |
|
|
|
2147 |
|
|
If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
|
2148 |
|
|
function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
|
2149 |
|
|
will cause the compiler to abort.
|
2150 |
|
|
|
2151 |
|
|
Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
|
2152 |
|
|
treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
|
2153 |
|
|
this.
|
2154 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2155 |
|
|
|
2156 |
|
|
@findex current_function_is_leaf
|
2157 |
|
|
@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
|
2158 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
|
2159 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
|
2160 |
|
|
specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
|
2161 |
|
|
which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
|
2162 |
|
|
set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
|
2163 |
|
|
compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
|
2164 |
|
|
@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
|
2165 |
|
|
functions which only use leaf registers.
|
2166 |
|
|
@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
|
2167 |
|
|
that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
|
2168 |
|
|
@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
|
2169 |
|
|
@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
|
2170 |
|
|
@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
|
2171 |
|
|
|
2172 |
|
|
@node Stack Registers
|
2173 |
|
|
@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
|
2174 |
|
|
|
2175 |
|
|
There are special features to handle computers where some of the
|
2176 |
|
|
``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
|
2177 |
|
|
pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
|
2178 |
|
|
stack.
|
2179 |
|
|
|
2180 |
|
|
Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
|
2181 |
|
|
they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
|
2182 |
|
|
support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
|
2183 |
|
|
point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
|
2184 |
|
|
stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
|
2185 |
|
|
@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
|
2186 |
|
|
with it, as well as defining these macros.
|
2187 |
|
|
|
2188 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_REGS
|
2189 |
|
|
Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
|
2190 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2191 |
|
|
|
2192 |
|
|
@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
|
2193 |
|
|
The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
|
2194 |
|
|
of the stack.
|
2195 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2196 |
|
|
|
2197 |
|
|
@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
|
2198 |
|
|
The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
|
2199 |
|
|
the stack.
|
2200 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2201 |
|
|
|
2202 |
|
|
@node Register Classes
|
2203 |
|
|
@section Register Classes
|
2204 |
|
|
@cindex register class definitions
|
2205 |
|
|
@cindex class definitions, register
|
2206 |
|
|
|
2207 |
|
|
On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
|
2208 |
|
|
For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
|
2209 |
|
|
certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
|
2210 |
|
|
restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
|
2211 |
|
|
|
2212 |
|
|
You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
|
2213 |
|
|
which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
|
2214 |
|
|
that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
|
2215 |
|
|
|
2216 |
|
|
@findex ALL_REGS
|
2217 |
|
|
@findex NO_REGS
|
2218 |
|
|
In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
|
2219 |
|
|
class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
|
2220 |
|
|
class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
|
2221 |
|
|
union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
|
2222 |
|
|
|
2223 |
|
|
@findex GENERAL_REGS
|
2224 |
|
|
One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
|
2225 |
|
|
terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
|
2226 |
|
|
@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
|
2227 |
|
|
the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
|
2228 |
|
|
to @code{ALL_REGS}.
|
2229 |
|
|
|
2230 |
|
|
Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
|
2231 |
|
|
then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
|
2232 |
|
|
|
2233 |
|
|
The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
|
2234 |
|
|
constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
|
2235 |
|
|
You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
|
2236 |
|
|
them in operand constraints.
|
2237 |
|
|
|
2238 |
|
|
You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
|
2239 |
|
|
instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
|
2240 |
|
|
either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
|
2241 |
|
|
certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
|
2242 |
|
|
which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
|
2243 |
|
|
|
2244 |
|
|
You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
|
2245 |
|
|
classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
|
2246 |
|
|
contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
|
2247 |
|
|
in their union.
|
2248 |
|
|
|
2249 |
|
|
When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
|
2250 |
|
|
certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
|
2251 |
|
|
Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
|
2252 |
|
|
a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
|
2253 |
|
|
specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
|
2254 |
|
|
|
2255 |
|
|
Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
|
2256 |
|
|
instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
|
2257 |
|
|
each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
|
2258 |
|
|
mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
|
2259 |
|
|
single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
|
2260 |
|
|
this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
|
2261 |
|
|
instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
|
2262 |
|
|
single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
|
2263 |
|
|
@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
|
2264 |
|
|
|
2265 |
|
|
@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
|
2266 |
|
|
An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
|
2267 |
|
|
as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
|
2268 |
|
|
must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
|
2269 |
|
|
@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
|
2270 |
|
|
tells how many classes there are.
|
2271 |
|
|
|
2272 |
|
|
Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
|
2273 |
|
|
the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
|
2274 |
|
|
in many of the tables described below.
|
2275 |
|
|
@end deftp
|
2276 |
|
|
|
2277 |
|
|
@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
|
2278 |
|
|
The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
|
2279 |
|
|
|
2280 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
2281 |
|
|
#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
|
2282 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
2283 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2284 |
|
|
|
2285 |
|
|
@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
|
2286 |
|
|
An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
|
2287 |
|
|
constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
|
2288 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2289 |
|
|
|
2290 |
|
|
@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
|
2291 |
|
|
An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
|
2292 |
|
|
which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
|
2293 |
|
|
@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
|
2294 |
|
|
register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
|
2295 |
|
|
|
2296 |
|
|
When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
|
2297 |
|
|
Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
|
2298 |
|
|
several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
|
2299 |
|
|
for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
|
2300 |
|
|
In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
|
2301 |
|
|
registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
|
2302 |
|
|
so on.
|
2303 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2304 |
|
|
|
2305 |
|
|
@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
|
2306 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
|
2307 |
|
|
@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
|
2308 |
|
|
which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
|
2309 |
|
|
register.
|
2310 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2311 |
|
|
|
2312 |
|
|
@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
|
2313 |
|
|
A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
|
2314 |
|
|
base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
|
2315 |
|
|
which is the register value plus a displacement.
|
2316 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2317 |
|
|
|
2318 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
|
2319 |
|
|
This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
|
2320 |
|
|
the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
|
2321 |
|
|
@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
|
2322 |
|
|
@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
|
2323 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2324 |
|
|
|
2325 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
|
2326 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
|
2327 |
|
|
base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
|
2328 |
|
|
register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
|
2329 |
|
|
addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
|
2330 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2331 |
|
|
|
2332 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
|
2333 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
|
2334 |
|
|
base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
|
2335 |
|
|
context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
|
2336 |
|
|
the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
|
2337 |
|
|
address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
|
2338 |
|
|
@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
|
2339 |
|
|
index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
|
2340 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2341 |
|
|
|
2342 |
|
|
@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
|
2343 |
|
|
A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
|
2344 |
|
|
index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
|
2345 |
|
|
address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
|
2346 |
|
|
added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
|
2347 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2348 |
|
|
|
2349 |
|
|
@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
|
2350 |
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
|
2351 |
|
|
suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses. It may be
|
2352 |
|
|
either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
|
2353 |
|
|
allocated such a hard register.
|
2354 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2355 |
|
|
|
2356 |
|
|
@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
|
2357 |
|
|
A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
|
2358 |
|
|
that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
|
2359 |
|
|
@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
|
2360 |
|
|
reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
|
2361 |
|
|
you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
|
2362 |
|
|
@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
|
2363 |
|
|
that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e. as an @code{address_operand}.
|
2364 |
|
|
|
2365 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2366 |
|
|
|
2367 |
|
|
@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
|
2368 |
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
|
2369 |
|
|
use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
|
2370 |
|
|
memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
|
2371 |
|
|
pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
|
2372 |
|
|
define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
|
2373 |
|
|
than other base register uses.
|
2374 |
|
|
|
2375 |
|
|
Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
|
2376 |
|
|
@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
|
2377 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2378 |
|
|
|
2379 |
|
|
@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
|
2380 |
|
|
A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
|
2381 |
|
|
that expression may examine the context in which the register appears in the
|
2382 |
|
|
memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the immediately enclosing
|
2383 |
|
|
expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the address, @code{ADDRESS} for
|
2384 |
|
|
something that occurs in an @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the
|
2385 |
|
|
code of the corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
|
2386 |
|
|
@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
|
2387 |
|
|
that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e. as an @code{address_operand}.
|
2388 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2389 |
|
|
|
2390 |
|
|
@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
|
2391 |
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
|
2392 |
|
|
suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
|
2393 |
|
|
either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
|
2394 |
|
|
allocated such a hard register.
|
2395 |
|
|
|
2396 |
|
|
The difference between an index register and a base register is that
|
2397 |
|
|
the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
|
2398 |
|
|
two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
|
2399 |
|
|
labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
|
2400 |
|
|
labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
|
2401 |
|
|
may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
|
2402 |
|
|
looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
|
2403 |
|
|
only if neither labeling works.
|
2404 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2405 |
|
|
|
2406 |
|
|
@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
|
2407 |
|
|
A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
|
2408 |
|
|
to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
|
2409 |
|
|
@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
|
2410 |
|
|
another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
|
2411 |
|
|
safe:
|
2412 |
|
|
|
2413 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
2414 |
|
|
#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
|
2415 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
2416 |
|
|
|
2417 |
|
|
Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
|
2418 |
|
|
example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
|
2419 |
|
|
for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
|
2420 |
|
|
@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
|
2421 |
|
|
Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
|
2422 |
|
|
|
2423 |
|
|
One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
|
2424 |
|
|
@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
|
2425 |
|
|
loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
|
2426 |
|
|
force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
|
2427 |
|
|
immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
|
2428 |
|
|
instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
|
2429 |
|
|
register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
|
2430 |
|
|
@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
|
2431 |
|
|
into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
|
2432 |
|
|
@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
|
2433 |
|
|
of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
|
2434 |
|
|
|
2435 |
|
|
If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
|
2436 |
|
|
through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
|
2437 |
|
|
to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
|
2438 |
|
|
reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
|
2439 |
|
|
this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
|
2440 |
|
|
the SSE registers (and vice versa).
|
2441 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2442 |
|
|
|
2443 |
|
|
@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
|
2444 |
|
|
Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
|
2445 |
|
|
input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
|
2446 |
|
|
@var{class}, unchanged.
|
2447 |
|
|
|
2448 |
|
|
You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
|
2449 |
|
|
reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
|
2450 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2451 |
|
|
|
2452 |
|
|
@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
|
2453 |
|
|
A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
|
2454 |
|
|
to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
|
2455 |
|
|
@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
|
2456 |
|
|
ordinarily be used.
|
2457 |
|
|
|
2458 |
|
|
Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
|
2459 |
|
|
there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
|
2460 |
|
|
|
2461 |
|
|
The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
|
2462 |
|
|
smaller class.
|
2463 |
|
|
|
2464 |
|
|
Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
|
2465 |
|
|
require the macro to do something nontrivial.
|
2466 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2467 |
|
|
|
2468 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} enum reg_class TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, enum reg_class @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
|
2469 |
|
|
Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
|
2470 |
|
|
from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
|
2471 |
|
|
@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
|
2472 |
|
|
from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
|
2473 |
|
|
term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
|
2474 |
|
|
directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
|
2475 |
|
|
register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
|
2476 |
|
|
destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
|
2477 |
|
|
source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
|
2478 |
|
|
reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
|
2479 |
|
|
and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
|
2480 |
|
|
intermediate register still holds the required value.
|
2481 |
|
|
|
2482 |
|
|
Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
|
2483 |
|
|
allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
|
2484 |
|
|
register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
|
2485 |
|
|
address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
|
2486 |
|
|
when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
|
2487 |
|
|
as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value that
|
2488 |
|
|
that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
|
2489 |
|
|
describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
|
2490 |
|
|
these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
|
2491 |
|
|
of the scratch register(s).
|
2492 |
|
|
|
2493 |
|
|
In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
|
2494 |
|
|
|
2495 |
|
|
For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
|
2496 |
|
|
and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register in of class
|
2497 |
|
|
@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
|
2498 |
|
|
hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_mode}
|
2499 |
|
|
needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
|
2500 |
|
|
|
2501 |
|
|
If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
|
2502 |
|
|
an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
|
2503 |
|
|
return the register class required for this intermediate register.
|
2504 |
|
|
If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
|
2505 |
|
|
If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
|
2506 |
|
|
that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
|
2507 |
|
|
|
2508 |
|
|
If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
|
2509 |
|
|
perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
|
2510 |
|
|
closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
|
2511 |
|
|
required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
|
2512 |
|
|
copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
|
2513 |
|
|
|
2514 |
|
|
You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
|
2515 |
|
|
in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
|
2516 |
|
|
and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
|
2517 |
|
|
for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
|
2518 |
|
|
single-register-class
|
2519 |
|
|
@c [later: or memory]
|
2520 |
|
|
output constraint.
|
2521 |
|
|
|
2522 |
|
|
When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
|
2523 |
|
|
hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
|
2524 |
|
|
register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
|
2525 |
|
|
have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
|
2526 |
|
|
|
2527 |
|
|
@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
|
2528 |
|
|
@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
|
2529 |
|
|
@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
|
2530 |
|
|
@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
|
2531 |
|
|
@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
|
2532 |
|
|
@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
|
2533 |
|
|
@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
|
2534 |
|
|
@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
|
2535 |
|
|
|
2536 |
|
|
|
2537 |
|
|
@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
|
2538 |
|
|
pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
|
2539 |
|
|
Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
|
2540 |
|
|
in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
|
2541 |
|
|
|
2542 |
|
|
Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
|
2543 |
|
|
currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
|
2544 |
|
|
to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
|
2545 |
|
|
|
2546 |
|
|
@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
|
2547 |
|
|
copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
|
2548 |
|
|
(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
|
2549 |
|
|
Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
|
2550 |
|
|
of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
|
2551 |
|
|
forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
|
2552 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
2553 |
|
|
|
2554 |
|
|
@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
|
2555 |
|
|
@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
|
2556 |
|
|
@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
|
2557 |
|
|
These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
|
2558 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
|
2559 |
|
|
|
2560 |
|
|
These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
|
2561 |
|
|
target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
|
2562 |
|
|
reload phase that it may
|
2563 |
|
|
need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
|
2564 |
|
|
register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
|
2565 |
|
|
register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
|
2566 |
|
|
you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
|
2567 |
|
|
largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
|
2568 |
|
|
intermediate registers or scratch registers.
|
2569 |
|
|
|
2570 |
|
|
If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
|
2571 |
|
|
intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
|
2572 |
|
|
was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
|
2573 |
|
|
class required. If the
|
2574 |
|
|
requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
|
2575 |
|
|
@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
|
2576 |
|
|
macros identically.
|
2577 |
|
|
|
2578 |
|
|
The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
|
2579 |
|
|
Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
|
2580 |
|
|
can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
|
2581 |
|
|
@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
|
2582 |
|
|
macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
|
2583 |
|
|
|
2584 |
|
|
If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
|
2585 |
|
|
intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
|
2586 |
|
|
@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
|
2587 |
|
|
(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
|
2588 |
|
|
implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
|
2589 |
|
|
@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
|
2590 |
|
|
register.
|
2591 |
|
|
|
2592 |
|
|
These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
|
2593 |
|
|
register that
|
2594 |
|
|
contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
|
2595 |
|
|
class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
|
2596 |
|
|
value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
|
2597 |
|
|
register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
|
2598 |
|
|
Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
|
2599 |
|
|
|
2600 |
|
|
@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
|
2601 |
|
|
pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
|
2602 |
|
|
Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
|
2603 |
|
|
in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
|
2604 |
|
|
|
2605 |
|
|
These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
|
2606 |
|
|
registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
|
2607 |
|
|
registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
|
2608 |
|
|
would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
|
2609 |
|
|
the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
|
2610 |
|
|
intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
|
2611 |
|
|
general registers.
|
2612 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2613 |
|
|
|
2614 |
|
|
@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
|
2615 |
|
|
Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
|
2616 |
|
|
to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
|
2617 |
|
|
those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
|
2618 |
|
|
@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
|
2619 |
|
|
class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
|
2620 |
|
|
and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
|
2621 |
|
|
|
2622 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
|
2623 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2624 |
|
|
|
2625 |
|
|
@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
|
2626 |
|
|
Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
|
2627 |
|
|
allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
|
2628 |
|
|
If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
|
2629 |
|
|
defined by this macro.
|
2630 |
|
|
|
2631 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if you do not define
|
2632 |
|
|
@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
|
2633 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2634 |
|
|
|
2635 |
|
|
@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
|
2636 |
|
|
When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
|
2637 |
|
|
registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
|
2638 |
|
|
hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
|
2639 |
|
|
load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
|
2640 |
|
|
same as that of @var{mode}.
|
2641 |
|
|
|
2642 |
|
|
This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
|
2643 |
|
|
bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
|
2644 |
|
|
in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
|
2645 |
|
|
registers.
|
2646 |
|
|
|
2647 |
|
|
However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
|
2648 |
|
|
the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
|
2649 |
|
|
differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
|
2650 |
|
|
widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
|
2651 |
|
|
suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
|
2652 |
|
|
details.
|
2653 |
|
|
|
2654 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if you do not define
|
2655 |
|
|
@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
|
2656 |
|
|
is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
|
2657 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2658 |
|
|
|
2659 |
|
|
@defmac SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
|
2660 |
|
|
On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
|
2661 |
|
|
insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
|
2662 |
|
|
to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
|
2663 |
|
|
if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
|
2664 |
|
|
insn.
|
2665 |
|
|
|
2666 |
|
|
Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a nonzero
|
2667 |
|
|
value on these machines. When this macro has a nonzero value, the
|
2668 |
|
|
compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
|
2669 |
|
|
|
2670 |
|
|
It is always safe to define this macro with a nonzero value, but if you
|
2671 |
|
|
unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
|
2672 |
|
|
that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this macro
|
2673 |
|
|
with a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
|
2674 |
|
|
spill registers and print a fatal error message. For most machines, you
|
2675 |
|
|
should not define this macro at all.
|
2676 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2677 |
|
|
|
2678 |
|
|
@defmac CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
|
2679 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
|
2680 |
|
|
to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
|
2681 |
|
|
registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
|
2682 |
|
|
|
2683 |
|
|
The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
|
2684 |
|
|
register and zero otherwise. On most machines, this default should be
|
2685 |
|
|
used. Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
|
2686 |
|
|
allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
|
2687 |
|
|
registers were needed for spill registers. If this macro returns nonzero
|
2688 |
|
|
for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
|
2689 |
|
|
@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
|
2690 |
|
|
register. If there would not be another register available for
|
2691 |
|
|
reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
|
2692 |
|
|
the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
|
2693 |
|
|
allocation.
|
2694 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2695 |
|
|
|
2696 |
|
|
@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
|
2697 |
|
|
A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
|
2698 |
|
|
of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
|
2699 |
|
|
|
2700 |
|
|
This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
|
2701 |
|
|
the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
|
2702 |
|
|
should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
|
2703 |
|
|
@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
|
2704 |
|
|
|
2705 |
|
|
This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
|
2706 |
|
|
in the reload pass.
|
2707 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2708 |
|
|
|
2709 |
|
|
@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
|
2710 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
|
2711 |
|
|
a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
|
2712 |
|
|
|
2713 |
|
|
For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
|
2714 |
|
|
floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
|
2715 |
|
|
Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
|
2716 |
|
|
does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
|
2717 |
|
|
register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
|
2718 |
|
|
as below:
|
2719 |
|
|
|
2720 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
2721 |
|
|
#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
|
2722 |
|
|
(GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
|
2723 |
|
|
? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
|
2724 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
2725 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2726 |
|
|
|
2727 |
|
|
@node Old Constraints
|
2728 |
|
|
@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
|
2729 |
|
|
@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
|
2730 |
|
|
@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
|
2731 |
|
|
|
2732 |
|
|
Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
|
2733 |
|
|
of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
|
2734 |
|
|
Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
|
2735 |
|
|
it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
|
2736 |
|
|
|
2737 |
|
|
@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
|
2738 |
|
|
For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
|
2739 |
|
|
@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
|
2740 |
|
|
constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
|
2741 |
|
|
you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
|
2742 |
|
|
constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
|
2743 |
|
|
DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
|
2744 |
|
|
to handle specially.
|
2745 |
|
|
There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
|
2746 |
|
|
for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
|
2747 |
|
|
transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
|
2748 |
|
|
return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
|
2749 |
|
|
will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
|
2750 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2751 |
|
|
|
2752 |
|
|
@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
|
2753 |
|
|
A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
|
2754 |
|
|
letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
|
2755 |
|
|
value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
|
2756 |
|
|
the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
|
2757 |
|
|
corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
|
2758 |
|
|
to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
|
2759 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2760 |
|
|
|
2761 |
|
|
@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
|
2762 |
|
|
Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
|
2763 |
|
|
passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
|
2764 |
|
|
different variants.
|
2765 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2766 |
|
|
|
2767 |
|
|
@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
|
2768 |
|
|
A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
|
2769 |
|
|
letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
|
2770 |
|
|
particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
|
2771 |
|
|
letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
|
2772 |
|
|
the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
|
2773 |
|
|
not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
|
2774 |
|
|
@var{value}.
|
2775 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2776 |
|
|
|
2777 |
|
|
@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
|
2778 |
|
|
Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
|
2779 |
|
|
string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
|
2780 |
|
|
between different variants.
|
2781 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2782 |
|
|
|
2783 |
|
|
@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
|
2784 |
|
|
A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
|
2785 |
|
|
letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
|
2786 |
|
|
(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
|
2787 |
|
|
|
2788 |
|
|
If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
|
2789 |
|
|
@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
|
2790 |
|
|
range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
|
2791 |
|
|
letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
|
2792 |
|
|
|
2793 |
|
|
@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
|
2794 |
|
|
@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
|
2795 |
|
|
or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
|
2796 |
|
|
between these kinds.
|
2797 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2798 |
|
|
|
2799 |
|
|
@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
|
2800 |
|
|
Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
|
2801 |
|
|
string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
|
2802 |
|
|
between different variants.
|
2803 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2804 |
|
|
|
2805 |
|
|
@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
|
2806 |
|
|
A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
|
2807 |
|
|
letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
|
2808 |
|
|
memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
|
2809 |
|
|
elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
|
2810 |
|
|
@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
|
2811 |
|
|
may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
|
2812 |
|
|
|
2813 |
|
|
If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
|
2814 |
|
|
if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
|
2815 |
|
|
constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
|
2816 |
|
|
constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
|
2817 |
|
|
|
2818 |
|
|
For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
|
2819 |
|
|
in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
|
2820 |
|
|
letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
|
2821 |
|
|
@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
|
2822 |
|
|
a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
|
2823 |
|
|
alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
|
2824 |
|
|
does not include r0 on the output.
|
2825 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2826 |
|
|
|
2827 |
|
|
@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
|
2828 |
|
|
Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
|
2829 |
|
|
in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
|
2830 |
|
|
variants.
|
2831 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2832 |
|
|
|
2833 |
|
|
@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
|
2834 |
|
|
A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
|
2835 |
|
|
letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
|
2836 |
|
|
be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
|
2837 |
|
|
|
2838 |
|
|
It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
|
2839 |
|
|
at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
|
2840 |
|
|
comprises a subset of all memory references including
|
2841 |
|
|
all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
|
2842 |
|
|
pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
|
2843 |
|
|
type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
|
2844 |
|
|
|
2845 |
|
|
For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
|
2846 |
|
|
memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
|
2847 |
|
|
register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
|
2848 |
|
|
@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
|
2849 |
|
|
If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
|
2850 |
|
|
a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
|
2851 |
|
|
reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
|
2852 |
|
|
into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
|
2853 |
|
|
a @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
|
2854 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2855 |
|
|
|
2856 |
|
|
@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
|
2857 |
|
|
A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
|
2858 |
|
|
letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
|
2859 |
|
|
@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
|
2860 |
|
|
be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
|
2861 |
|
|
|
2862 |
|
|
It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
|
2863 |
|
|
at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
|
2864 |
|
|
a subset of all memory addresses including
|
2865 |
|
|
all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
|
2866 |
|
|
pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
|
2867 |
|
|
type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
|
2868 |
|
|
|
2869 |
|
|
Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
|
2870 |
|
|
be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
|
2871 |
|
|
analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
|
2872 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2873 |
|
|
|
2874 |
|
|
@node Stack and Calling
|
2875 |
|
|
@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
|
2876 |
|
|
@cindex calling conventions
|
2877 |
|
|
|
2878 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
2879 |
|
|
This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
|
2880 |
|
|
|
2881 |
|
|
@menu
|
2882 |
|
|
* Frame Layout::
|
2883 |
|
|
* Exception Handling::
|
2884 |
|
|
* Stack Checking::
|
2885 |
|
|
* Frame Registers::
|
2886 |
|
|
* Elimination::
|
2887 |
|
|
* Stack Arguments::
|
2888 |
|
|
* Register Arguments::
|
2889 |
|
|
* Scalar Return::
|
2890 |
|
|
* Aggregate Return::
|
2891 |
|
|
* Caller Saves::
|
2892 |
|
|
* Function Entry::
|
2893 |
|
|
* Profiling::
|
2894 |
|
|
* Tail Calls::
|
2895 |
|
|
* Stack Smashing Protection::
|
2896 |
|
|
@end menu
|
2897 |
|
|
|
2898 |
|
|
@node Frame Layout
|
2899 |
|
|
@subsection Basic Stack Layout
|
2900 |
|
|
@cindex stack frame layout
|
2901 |
|
|
@cindex frame layout
|
2902 |
|
|
|
2903 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
2904 |
|
|
Here is the basic stack layout.
|
2905 |
|
|
|
2906 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
2907 |
|
|
Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
|
2908 |
|
|
pointer to a smaller address.
|
2909 |
|
|
|
2910 |
|
|
When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
|
2911 |
|
|
compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
|
2912 |
|
|
definition used does not matter.
|
2913 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2914 |
|
|
|
2915 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
|
2916 |
|
|
This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
|
2917 |
|
|
on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
|
2918 |
|
|
@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
|
2919 |
|
|
|
2920 |
|
|
The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
|
2921 |
|
|
and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
|
2922 |
|
|
the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
|
2923 |
|
|
to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
|
2924 |
|
|
space for the next item on the stack.
|
2925 |
|
|
|
2926 |
|
|
The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
|
2927 |
|
|
defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
|
2928 |
|
|
which is often wrong.
|
2929 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2930 |
|
|
|
2931 |
|
|
@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
2932 |
|
|
Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
|
2933 |
|
|
are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
|
2934 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2935 |
|
|
|
2936 |
|
|
@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
2937 |
|
|
Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
|
2938 |
|
|
addresses on the stack.
|
2939 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2940 |
|
|
|
2941 |
|
|
@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
|
2942 |
|
|
Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
|
2943 |
|
|
|
2944 |
|
|
If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
|
2945 |
|
|
subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
|
2946 |
|
|
Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
|
2947 |
|
|
value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
|
2948 |
|
|
@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
|
2949 |
|
|
@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
|
2950 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2951 |
|
|
|
2952 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
|
2953 |
|
|
Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
|
2954 |
|
|
The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
|
2955 |
|
|
|
2956 |
|
|
On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
|
2957 |
|
|
is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
|
2958 |
|
|
alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
|
2959 |
|
|
stack alignment and do it in the backend.
|
2960 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2961 |
|
|
|
2962 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
|
2963 |
|
|
Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
|
2964 |
|
|
outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
|
2965 |
|
|
zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
|
2966 |
|
|
|
2967 |
|
|
If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
|
2968 |
|
|
the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
|
2969 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2970 |
|
|
|
2971 |
|
|
@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
|
2972 |
|
|
Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
|
2973 |
|
|
address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
|
2974 |
|
|
function.
|
2975 |
|
|
|
2976 |
|
|
If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
|
2977 |
|
|
the first argument's address.
|
2978 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2979 |
|
|
|
2980 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
|
2981 |
|
|
Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
|
2982 |
|
|
on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
|
2983 |
|
|
|
2984 |
|
|
The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
|
2985 |
|
|
length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
|
2986 |
|
|
machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
|
2987 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2988 |
|
|
|
2989 |
|
|
@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
|
2990 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
|
2991 |
|
|
stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
|
2992 |
|
|
@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
|
2993 |
|
|
default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
|
2994 |
|
|
elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
|
2995 |
|
|
@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
|
2996 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
2997 |
|
|
|
2998 |
|
|
@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
|
2999 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
|
3000 |
|
|
frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
|
3001 |
|
|
@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
|
3002 |
|
|
itself.
|
3003 |
|
|
|
3004 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
|
3005 |
|
|
of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
|
3006 |
|
|
address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
|
3007 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3008 |
|
|
|
3009 |
|
|
@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
|
3010 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
|
3011 |
|
|
setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
|
3012 |
|
|
on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
|
3013 |
|
|
before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
|
3014 |
|
|
define this macro.
|
3015 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3016 |
|
|
|
3017 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE ()
|
3018 |
|
|
This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
|
3019 |
|
|
the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
|
3020 |
|
|
The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
|
3021 |
|
|
machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
|
3022 |
|
|
@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
|
3023 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
3024 |
|
|
|
3025 |
|
|
@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
|
3026 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
|
3027 |
|
|
address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
|
3028 |
|
|
of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
|
3029 |
|
|
You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
|
3030 |
|
|
as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
|
3031 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3032 |
|
|
|
3033 |
|
|
@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
|
3034 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
|
3035 |
|
|
address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
|
3036 |
|
|
the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
|
3037 |
|
|
frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
|
3038 |
|
|
@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
|
3039 |
|
|
|
3040 |
|
|
The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
|
3041 |
|
|
@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
|
3042 |
|
|
determine the return address of other frames.
|
3043 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3044 |
|
|
|
3045 |
|
|
@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
|
3046 |
|
|
Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
|
3047 |
|
|
from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
|
3048 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3049 |
|
|
|
3050 |
|
|
@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
|
3051 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
|
3052 |
|
|
incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
|
3053 |
|
|
prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
|
3054 |
|
|
value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
|
3055 |
|
|
the stack.
|
3056 |
|
|
|
3057 |
|
|
You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
|
3058 |
|
|
debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
|
3059 |
|
|
|
3060 |
|
|
If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
|
3061 |
|
|
@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
|
3062 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3063 |
|
|
|
3064 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
|
3065 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
|
3066 |
|
|
number that may be used as an alternate return column. This should
|
3067 |
|
|
be defined only if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
|
3068 |
|
|
general register, but an alternate column needs to be used for
|
3069 |
|
|
signal frames.
|
3070 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3071 |
|
|
|
3072 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
|
3073 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
|
3074 |
|
|
number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
|
3075 |
|
|
only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
|
3076 |
|
|
someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
|
3077 |
|
|
terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
|
3078 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3079 |
|
|
|
3080 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
|
3081 |
|
|
This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
|
3082 |
|
|
contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
|
3083 |
|
|
info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
|
3084 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3085 |
|
|
(set (reg) (unspec [...] UNSPEC_INDEX))
|
3086 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3087 |
|
|
and
|
3088 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3089 |
|
|
(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [...] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
|
3090 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3091 |
|
|
to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
|
3092 |
|
|
the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
|
3093 |
|
|
the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
|
3094 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
3095 |
|
|
|
3096 |
|
|
@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
|
3097 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
|
3098 |
|
|
from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
|
3099 |
|
|
frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
|
3100 |
|
|
the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
|
3101 |
|
|
previous frame, just before the call instruction.
|
3102 |
|
|
|
3103 |
|
|
You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
|
3104 |
|
|
debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
|
3105 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3106 |
|
|
|
3107 |
|
|
@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
|
3108 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
|
3109 |
|
|
from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
|
3110 |
|
|
final value should coincide with that calculated by
|
3111 |
|
|
@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
|
3112 |
|
|
during virtual register instantiation.
|
3113 |
|
|
|
3114 |
|
|
The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
|
3115 |
|
|
which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
|
3116 |
|
|
immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
|
3117 |
|
|
some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
|
3118 |
|
|
and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
|
3119 |
|
|
|
3120 |
|
|
You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
|
3121 |
|
|
want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
|
3122 |
|
|
DWARF 2.
|
3123 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3124 |
|
|
|
3125 |
|
|
@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
|
3126 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
|
3127 |
|
|
in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
|
3128 |
|
|
The final value should coincide with that calculated by
|
3129 |
|
|
@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
|
3130 |
|
|
|
3131 |
|
|
Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
|
3132 |
|
|
via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
|
3133 |
|
|
variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
|
3134 |
|
|
defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
|
3135 |
|
|
based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
|
3136 |
|
|
of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
|
3137 |
|
|
should be defined.
|
3138 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3139 |
|
|
|
3140 |
|
|
@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
|
3141 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
|
3142 |
|
|
in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
|
3143 |
|
|
in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
|
3144 |
|
|
may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
|
3145 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3146 |
|
|
|
3147 |
|
|
@node Exception Handling
|
3148 |
|
|
@subsection Exception Handling Support
|
3149 |
|
|
@cindex exception handling
|
3150 |
|
|
|
3151 |
|
|
@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
|
3152 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
|
3153 |
|
|
data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
|
3154 |
|
|
@var{N} registers are usable.
|
3155 |
|
|
|
3156 |
|
|
The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
|
3157 |
|
|
handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
|
3158 |
|
|
should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
|
3159 |
|
|
but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
|
3160 |
|
|
2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
|
3161 |
|
|
|
3162 |
|
|
You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
|
3163 |
|
|
handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
|
3164 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3165 |
|
|
|
3166 |
|
|
@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
|
3167 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
|
3168 |
|
|
to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
|
3169 |
|
|
This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
|
3170 |
|
|
It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
|
3171 |
|
|
|
3172 |
|
|
Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
|
3173 |
|
|
untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
|
3174 |
|
|
|
3175 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
|
3176 |
|
|
by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
|
3177 |
|
|
this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
|
3178 |
|
|
stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
|
3179 |
|
|
this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
|
3180 |
|
|
that provided by DWARF 2.
|
3181 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3182 |
|
|
|
3183 |
|
|
@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
|
3184 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
|
3185 |
|
|
to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
|
3186 |
|
|
return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
|
3187 |
|
|
|
3188 |
|
|
Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
|
3189 |
|
|
return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
|
3190 |
|
|
address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
|
3191 |
|
|
the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
|
3192 |
|
|
frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
|
3193 |
|
|
been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
|
3194 |
|
|
target call frame.
|
3195 |
|
|
|
3196 |
|
|
Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
|
3197 |
|
|
address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
|
3198 |
|
|
the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
|
3199 |
|
|
|
3200 |
|
|
If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
|
3201 |
|
|
define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
|
3202 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3203 |
|
|
|
3204 |
|
|
@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
|
3205 |
|
|
If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
|
3206 |
|
|
to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
|
3207 |
|
|
exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
|
3208 |
|
|
using it to return to the exception handler.
|
3209 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3210 |
|
|
|
3211 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
|
3212 |
|
|
This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
|
3213 |
|
|
handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
|
3214 |
|
|
that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
|
3215 |
|
|
and so may be read-only.
|
3216 |
|
|
|
3217 |
|
|
@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
|
3218 |
|
|
@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
|
3219 |
|
|
The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
|
3220 |
|
|
as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
|
3221 |
|
|
|
3222 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
|
3223 |
|
|
represented directly.
|
3224 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3225 |
|
|
|
3226 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
|
3227 |
|
|
This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
|
3228 |
|
|
to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
|
3229 |
|
|
Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
|
3230 |
|
|
be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
|
3231 |
|
|
|
3232 |
|
|
This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
|
3233 |
|
|
handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
|
3234 |
|
|
of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
|
3235 |
|
|
to be emitted.
|
3236 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3237 |
|
|
|
3238 |
|
|
@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
|
3239 |
|
|
A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
|
3240 |
|
|
so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
|
3241 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3242 |
|
|
|
3243 |
|
|
@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
|
3244 |
|
|
This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
|
3245 |
|
|
code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
|
3246 |
|
|
available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
|
3247 |
|
|
through signal frames.
|
3248 |
|
|
|
3249 |
|
|
This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
|
3250 |
|
|
and @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
|
3251 |
|
|
@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
|
3252 |
|
|
for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
|
3253 |
|
|
the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register save
|
3254 |
|
|
addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should evaluate to
|
3255 |
|
|
@code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should
|
3256 |
|
|
evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
|
3257 |
|
|
|
3258 |
|
|
For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
|
3259 |
|
|
@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
|
3260 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3261 |
|
|
|
3262 |
|
|
@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
|
3263 |
|
|
This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
|
3264 |
|
|
call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
|
3265 |
|
|
usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
|
3266 |
|
|
|
3267 |
|
|
This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
|
3268 |
|
|
@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
|
3269 |
|
|
@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
|
3270 |
|
|
for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
|
3271 |
|
|
@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
|
3272 |
|
|
be updated in @var{fs}.
|
3273 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3274 |
|
|
|
3275 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
|
3276 |
|
|
A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
|
3277 |
|
|
info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
|
3278 |
|
|
linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
|
3279 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3280 |
|
|
|
3281 |
|
|
@node Stack Checking
|
3282 |
|
|
@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
|
3283 |
|
|
|
3284 |
|
|
GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
|
3285 |
|
|
the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
|
3286 |
|
|
|
3287 |
|
|
@enumerate
|
3288 |
|
|
@item
|
3289 |
|
|
If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
|
3290 |
|
|
will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
|
3291 |
|
|
appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
|
3292 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}. GCC will do not other special
|
3293 |
|
|
processing.
|
3294 |
|
|
|
3295 |
|
|
@item
|
3296 |
|
|
If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
|
3297 |
|
|
called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
|
3298 |
|
|
pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
|
3299 |
|
|
value against. You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
|
3300 |
|
|
the stack pointer is out of range.
|
3301 |
|
|
|
3302 |
|
|
@item
|
3303 |
|
|
If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
|
3304 |
|
|
``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
|
3305 |
|
|
@end enumerate
|
3306 |
|
|
|
3307 |
|
|
Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
|
3308 |
|
|
will use the third approach.
|
3309 |
|
|
|
3310 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
|
3311 |
|
|
A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
|
3312 |
|
|
machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
|
3313 |
|
|
is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
|
3314 |
|
|
checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
|
3315 |
|
|
The default value of this macro is zero.
|
3316 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3317 |
|
|
|
3318 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
|
3319 |
|
|
An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
|
3320 |
|
|
probe instructions. You will normally define this macro to be no larger
|
3321 |
|
|
than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The
|
3322 |
|
|
default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
|
3323 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3324 |
|
|
|
3325 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
|
3326 |
|
|
A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
|
3327 |
|
|
as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
|
3328 |
|
|
The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
|
3329 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3330 |
|
|
|
3331 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
|
3332 |
|
|
The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
|
3333 |
|
|
for languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of
|
3334 |
|
|
75 words should be adequate for most machines.
|
3335 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3336 |
|
|
|
3337 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
|
3338 |
|
|
The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
|
3339 |
|
|
instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
|
3340 |
|
|
stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
|
3341 |
|
|
checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
|
3342 |
|
|
default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
|
3343 |
|
|
systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
|
3344 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3345 |
|
|
|
3346 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
|
3347 |
|
|
GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
|
3348 |
|
|
represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
|
3349 |
|
|
space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
|
3350 |
|
|
You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
|
3351 |
|
|
use the default of four words.
|
3352 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3353 |
|
|
|
3354 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
|
3355 |
|
|
The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
|
3356 |
|
|
fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
|
3357 |
|
|
@option{-fstack-check}.
|
3358 |
|
|
GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
|
3359 |
|
|
normally not need to override that default.
|
3360 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3361 |
|
|
|
3362 |
|
|
@need 2000
|
3363 |
|
|
@node Frame Registers
|
3364 |
|
|
@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
|
3365 |
|
|
|
3366 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
3367 |
|
|
This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
|
3368 |
|
|
|
3369 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
3370 |
|
|
The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
|
3371 |
|
|
fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
|
3372 |
|
|
the hardware determines which register this is.
|
3373 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3374 |
|
|
|
3375 |
|
|
@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
3376 |
|
|
The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
|
3377 |
|
|
access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
|
3378 |
|
|
hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
|
3379 |
|
|
choose any register you wish for this purpose.
|
3380 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3381 |
|
|
|
3382 |
|
|
@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
3383 |
|
|
On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
|
3384 |
|
|
offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
|
3385 |
|
|
allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
|
3386 |
|
|
between these two locations). On those machines, define
|
3387 |
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
|
3388 |
|
|
be used internally until the offset is known, and define
|
3389 |
|
|
@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
|
3390 |
|
|
used for the frame pointer.
|
3391 |
|
|
|
3392 |
|
|
You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
|
3393 |
|
|
is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
|
3394 |
|
|
the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
|
3395 |
|
|
completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
|
3396 |
|
|
definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
|
3397 |
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
|
3398 |
|
|
or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
|
3399 |
|
|
|
3400 |
|
|
Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
|
3401 |
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
|
3402 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3403 |
|
|
|
3404 |
|
|
@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
3405 |
|
|
The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
|
3406 |
|
|
the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
|
3407 |
|
|
frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
|
3408 |
|
|
register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
|
3409 |
|
|
wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
|
3410 |
|
|
pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
|
3411 |
|
|
@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
|
3412 |
|
|
(@pxref{Elimination}).
|
3413 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3414 |
|
|
|
3415 |
|
|
@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
|
3416 |
|
|
The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
|
3417 |
|
|
access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
|
3418 |
|
|
machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
|
3419 |
|
|
pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
|
3420 |
|
|
to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
|
3421 |
|
|
@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
|
3422 |
|
|
|
3423 |
|
|
Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
|
3424 |
|
|
address from the stack.
|
3425 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3426 |
|
|
|
3427 |
|
|
@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
|
3428 |
|
|
@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
|
3429 |
|
|
Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
|
3430 |
|
|
register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
|
3431 |
|
|
function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
|
3432 |
|
|
number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
|
3433 |
|
|
these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
|
3434 |
|
|
not be defined.
|
3435 |
|
|
|
3436 |
|
|
The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
|
3437 |
|
|
|
3438 |
|
|
If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
|
3439 |
|
|
defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
|
3440 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3441 |
|
|
|
3442 |
|
|
@defmac STATIC_CHAIN
|
3443 |
|
|
@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
|
3444 |
|
|
If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
|
3445 |
|
|
@code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
|
3446 |
|
|
@code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
|
3447 |
|
|
as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively. Often the former
|
3448 |
|
|
will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
|
3449 |
|
|
the frame pointer.
|
3450 |
|
|
|
3451 |
|
|
@findex stack_pointer_rtx
|
3452 |
|
|
@findex frame_pointer_rtx
|
3453 |
|
|
@findex arg_pointer_rtx
|
3454 |
|
|
The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
|
3455 |
|
|
@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
|
3456 |
|
|
macros and should be used to refer to those items.
|
3457 |
|
|
|
3458 |
|
|
If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
|
3459 |
|
|
be defined instead.
|
3460 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3461 |
|
|
|
3462 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
|
3463 |
|
|
This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
|
3464 |
|
|
saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
|
3465 |
|
|
DWARF2 exception handling.
|
3466 |
|
|
|
3467 |
|
|
Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
|
3468 |
|
|
exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
|
3469 |
|
|
extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
|
3470 |
|
|
in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
|
3471 |
|
|
used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
|
3472 |
|
|
routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
|
3473 |
|
|
registers that are not call-saved.
|
3474 |
|
|
|
3475 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
|
3476 |
|
|
@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
|
3477 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3478 |
|
|
|
3479 |
|
|
@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
|
3480 |
|
|
|
3481 |
|
|
This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
|
3482 |
|
|
for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
|
3483 |
|
|
|
3484 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
|
3485 |
|
|
@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
|
3486 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3487 |
|
|
|
3488 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
|
3489 |
|
|
|
3490 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
|
3491 |
|
|
is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
|
3492 |
|
|
Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
|
3493 |
|
|
column number to use instead.
|
3494 |
|
|
|
3495 |
|
|
See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
|
3496 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3497 |
|
|
|
3498 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
|
3499 |
|
|
|
3500 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
|
3501 |
|
|
used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
|
3502 |
|
|
debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
|
3503 |
|
|
should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
|
3504 |
|
|
@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
|
3505 |
|
|
|
3506 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3507 |
|
|
|
3508 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
|
3509 |
|
|
|
3510 |
|
|
Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
|
3511 |
|
|
that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
|
3512 |
|
|
should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
|
3513 |
|
|
.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
|
3514 |
|
|
return @code{@var{regno}}.
|
3515 |
|
|
|
3516 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3517 |
|
|
|
3518 |
|
|
@node Elimination
|
3519 |
|
|
@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
|
3520 |
|
|
|
3521 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
3522 |
|
|
This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
|
3523 |
|
|
|
3524 |
|
|
@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
|
3525 |
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
|
3526 |
|
|
pointer. This expression is evaluated in the reload pass. If its value is
|
3527 |
|
|
nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
|
3528 |
|
|
|
3529 |
|
|
The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
|
3530 |
|
|
according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
|
3531 |
|
|
constant 1 suffices. Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
|
3532 |
|
|
with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space. Use 1
|
3533 |
|
|
when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
|
3534 |
|
|
|
3535 |
|
|
In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
|
3536 |
|
|
without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
|
3537 |
|
|
automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
|
3538 |
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says. You don't need to worry about
|
3539 |
|
|
them.
|
3540 |
|
|
|
3541 |
|
|
In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
|
3542 |
|
|
register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
|
3543 |
|
|
fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
|
3544 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3545 |
|
|
|
3546 |
|
|
@findex get_frame_size
|
3547 |
|
|
@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
|
3548 |
|
|
A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
|
3549 |
|
|
between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
|
3550 |
|
|
the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
|
3551 |
|
|
such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
|
3552 |
|
|
registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
|
3553 |
|
|
|
3554 |
|
|
If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
|
3555 |
|
|
need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
|
3556 |
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
|
3557 |
|
|
case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
|
3558 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3559 |
|
|
|
3560 |
|
|
@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
|
3561 |
|
|
If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
|
3562 |
|
|
eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
|
3563 |
|
|
defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
|
3564 |
|
|
references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
|
3565 |
|
|
|
3566 |
|
|
The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
|
3567 |
|
|
of which specifies an original and replacement register.
|
3568 |
|
|
|
3569 |
|
|
On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
|
3570 |
|
|
the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
|
3571 |
|
|
must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
|
3572 |
|
|
replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
|
3573 |
|
|
depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
|
3574 |
|
|
|
3575 |
|
|
In this case, you might specify:
|
3576 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3577 |
|
|
#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
|
3578 |
|
|
@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
|
3579 |
|
|
@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
|
3580 |
|
|
@{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
|
3581 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3582 |
|
|
|
3583 |
|
|
Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
|
3584 |
|
|
specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
|
3585 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3586 |
|
|
|
3587 |
|
|
@defmac CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
|
3588 |
|
|
A C expression that returns nonzero if the compiler is allowed to try
|
3589 |
|
|
to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
|
3590 |
|
|
@var{to-reg}. This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
|
3591 |
|
|
is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
|
3592 |
|
|
preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
|
3593 |
|
|
knows about.
|
3594 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3595 |
|
|
|
3596 |
|
|
@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
|
3597 |
|
|
This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
|
3598 |
|
|
specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
|
3599 |
|
|
registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
|
3600 |
|
|
defined.
|
3601 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3602 |
|
|
|
3603 |
|
|
@node Stack Arguments
|
3604 |
|
|
@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
|
3605 |
|
|
@cindex arguments on stack
|
3606 |
|
|
@cindex stack arguments
|
3607 |
|
|
|
3608 |
|
|
The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
|
3609 |
|
|
on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
|
3610 |
|
|
control passing certain arguments in registers.
|
3611 |
|
|
|
3612 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (tree @var{fntype})
|
3613 |
|
|
This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
|
3614 |
|
|
prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
|
3615 |
|
|
passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
|
3616 |
|
|
cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
|
3617 |
|
|
The default is to not promote prototypes.
|
3618 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
3619 |
|
|
|
3620 |
|
|
@defmac PUSH_ARGS
|
3621 |
|
|
A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
|
3622 |
|
|
outgoing arguments.
|
3623 |
|
|
If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
|
3624 |
|
|
That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
|
3625 |
|
|
allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
|
3626 |
|
|
it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
|
3627 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3628 |
|
|
|
3629 |
|
|
@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
|
3630 |
|
|
A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
|
3631 |
|
|
last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
|
3632 |
|
|
defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
|
3633 |
|
|
and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
|
3634 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3635 |
|
|
|
3636 |
|
|
@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
|
3637 |
|
|
A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
|
3638 |
|
|
stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
|
3639 |
|
|
|
3640 |
|
|
On some machines, the definition
|
3641 |
|
|
|
3642 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3643 |
|
|
#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
|
3644 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3645 |
|
|
|
3646 |
|
|
@noindent
|
3647 |
|
|
will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
|
3648 |
|
|
to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
|
3649 |
|
|
alignment. Then the definition should be
|
3650 |
|
|
|
3651 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
3652 |
|
|
#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
|
3653 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
3654 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3655 |
|
|
|
3656 |
|
|
@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
|
3657 |
|
|
@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
|
3658 |
|
|
A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
|
3659 |
|
|
will be computed and placed into the variable
|
3660 |
|
|
@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
|
3661 |
|
|
onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
|
3662 |
|
|
increase the stack frame size by this amount.
|
3663 |
|
|
|
3664 |
|
|
Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
|
3665 |
|
|
is not proper.
|
3666 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3667 |
|
|
|
3668 |
|
|
@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
|
3669 |
|
|
Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
|
3670 |
|
|
allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
|
3671 |
|
|
registers.
|
3672 |
|
|
|
3673 |
|
|
The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
|
3674 |
|
|
arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
|
3675 |
|
|
which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
|
3676 |
|
|
|
3677 |
|
|
This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
|
3678 |
|
|
machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
|
3679 |
|
|
which.
|
3680 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3681 |
|
|
@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
|
3682 |
|
|
@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
|
3683 |
|
|
|
3684 |
|
|
@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
3685 |
|
|
Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
|
3686 |
|
|
reserved for arguments passed in registers.
|
3687 |
|
|
|
3688 |
|
|
If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
|
3689 |
|
|
whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
|
3690 |
|
|
@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
|
3691 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3692 |
|
|
|
3693 |
|
|
@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
|
3694 |
|
|
Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
|
3695 |
|
|
stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
|
3696 |
|
|
@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
|
3697 |
|
|
@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
|
3698 |
|
|
|
3699 |
|
|
Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
|
3700 |
|
|
stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
|
3701 |
|
|
suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
|
3702 |
|
|
stack in its natural location.
|
3703 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3704 |
|
|
|
3705 |
|
|
@defmac RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
|
3706 |
|
|
A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
|
3707 |
|
|
arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
|
3708 |
|
|
function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
|
3709 |
|
|
after the function returns.
|
3710 |
|
|
|
3711 |
|
|
@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
|
3712 |
|
|
the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
|
3713 |
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
|
3714 |
|
|
From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
|
3715 |
|
|
|
3716 |
|
|
@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
|
3717 |
|
|
describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
|
3718 |
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
|
3719 |
|
|
From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
|
3720 |
|
|
arguments (if known).
|
3721 |
|
|
|
3722 |
|
|
When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
|
3723 |
|
|
will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
|
3724 |
|
|
you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
|
3725 |
|
|
by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
|
3726 |
|
|
a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
|
3727 |
|
|
in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
|
3728 |
|
|
|
3729 |
|
|
@var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
|
3730 |
|
|
stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
|
3731 |
|
|
argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
|
3732 |
|
|
|
3733 |
|
|
On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
|
3734 |
|
|
of this macro is @var{stack-size}. On the 68000, using the standard
|
3735 |
|
|
calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
|
3736 |
|
|
the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
|
3737 |
|
|
convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
|
3738 |
|
|
arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
|
3739 |
|
|
nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
|
3740 |
|
|
@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
|
3741 |
|
|
number of arguments.
|
3742 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3743 |
|
|
|
3744 |
|
|
@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
|
3745 |
|
|
A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
|
3746 |
|
|
pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
|
3747 |
|
|
when compiling a function call.
|
3748 |
|
|
|
3749 |
|
|
@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
|
3750 |
|
|
have been accumulated.
|
3751 |
|
|
|
3752 |
|
|
On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
|
3753 |
|
|
that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
|
3754 |
|
|
that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
|
3755 |
|
|
call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
|
3756 |
|
|
appropriate.
|
3757 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3758 |
|
|
|
3759 |
|
|
@node Register Arguments
|
3760 |
|
|
@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
|
3761 |
|
|
@cindex arguments in registers
|
3762 |
|
|
@cindex registers arguments
|
3763 |
|
|
|
3764 |
|
|
This section describes the macros which let you control how various
|
3765 |
|
|
types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
|
3766 |
|
|
the stack.
|
3767 |
|
|
|
3768 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
3769 |
|
|
A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
|
3770 |
|
|
in a register, and which register.
|
3771 |
|
|
|
3772 |
|
|
The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
|
3773 |
|
|
arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
|
3774 |
|
|
the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
|
3775 |
|
|
(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
|
3776 |
|
|
which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
|
3777 |
|
|
correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
|
3778 |
|
|
@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
|
3779 |
|
|
occurred.
|
3780 |
|
|
|
3781 |
|
|
The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
|
3782 |
|
|
hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
|
3783 |
|
|
argument on the stack.
|
3784 |
|
|
|
3785 |
|
|
For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
|
3786 |
|
|
pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
|
3787 |
|
|
|
3788 |
|
|
The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
|
3789 |
|
|
used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
|
3790 |
|
|
@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
|
3791 |
|
|
@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
|
3792 |
|
|
describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
|
3793 |
|
|
@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
|
3794 |
|
|
register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
|
3795 |
|
|
register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
|
3796 |
|
|
second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
|
3797 |
|
|
the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
|
3798 |
|
|
As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
|
3799 |
|
|
RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
|
3800 |
|
|
argument is also stored on the stack.
|
3801 |
|
|
|
3802 |
|
|
The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
|
3803 |
|
|
VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
|
3804 |
|
|
pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
|
3805 |
|
|
|
3806 |
|
|
@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
|
3807 |
|
|
The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
|
3808 |
|
|
where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
|
3809 |
|
|
nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
|
3810 |
|
|
by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
|
3811 |
|
|
|
3812 |
|
|
@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
|
3813 |
|
|
@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
|
3814 |
|
|
You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
|
3815 |
|
|
in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
|
3816 |
|
|
type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
|
3817 |
|
|
is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
|
3818 |
|
|
argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
|
3819 |
|
|
defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
|
3820 |
|
|
a register.
|
3821 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3822 |
|
|
|
3823 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type})
|
3824 |
|
|
This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
|
3825 |
|
|
solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
|
3826 |
|
|
definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
|
3827 |
|
|
documentation.
|
3828 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
3829 |
|
|
|
3830 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
3831 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
|
3832 |
|
|
that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
|
3833 |
|
|
necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
|
3834 |
|
|
argument.
|
3835 |
|
|
|
3836 |
|
|
For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
|
3837 |
|
|
the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
|
3838 |
|
|
be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
|
3839 |
|
|
where the arguments will arrive.
|
3840 |
|
|
|
3841 |
|
|
If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
|
3842 |
|
|
serves both purposes.
|
3843 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3844 |
|
|
|
3845 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
|
3846 |
|
|
This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
|
3847 |
|
|
argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
|
3848 |
|
|
arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
|
3849 |
|
|
pushed on the stack.
|
3850 |
|
|
|
3851 |
|
|
On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
|
3852 |
|
|
registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
|
3853 |
|
|
first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
|
3854 |
|
|
on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
|
3855 |
|
|
structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
|
3856 |
|
|
in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
|
3857 |
|
|
compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
|
3858 |
|
|
|
3859 |
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
|
3860 |
|
|
register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
|
3861 |
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
|
3862 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
3863 |
|
|
|
3864 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
|
3865 |
|
|
This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
|
3866 |
|
|
position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
|
3867 |
|
|
predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
|
3868 |
|
|
passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
|
3869 |
|
|
|
3870 |
|
|
If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
|
3871 |
|
|
pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
|
3872 |
|
|
The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
|
3873 |
|
|
to that type.
|
3874 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
3875 |
|
|
|
3876 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
|
3877 |
|
|
The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
|
3878 |
|
|
known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
|
3879 |
|
|
function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
|
3880 |
|
|
by the caller.
|
3881 |
|
|
|
3882 |
|
|
For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
|
3883 |
|
|
determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
|
3884 |
|
|
not be generated.
|
3885 |
|
|
|
3886 |
|
|
The default version of this hook always returns false.
|
3887 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
3888 |
|
|
|
3889 |
|
|
@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
|
3890 |
|
|
A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
|
3891 |
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
|
3892 |
|
|
the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
|
3893 |
|
|
argument so far.
|
3894 |
|
|
|
3895 |
|
|
There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
|
3896 |
|
|
arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
|
3897 |
|
|
variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
|
3898 |
|
|
arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
|
3899 |
|
|
@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
|
3900 |
|
|
should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
|
3901 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3902 |
|
|
|
3903 |
|
|
@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
|
3904 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
|
3905 |
|
|
@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
|
3906 |
|
|
variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
|
3907 |
|
|
is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
|
3908 |
|
|
the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
|
3909 |
|
|
For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
|
3910 |
|
|
declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
|
3911 |
|
|
@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
|
3912 |
|
|
being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
|
3913 |
|
|
arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
|
3914 |
|
|
parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
|
3915 |
|
|
@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
|
3916 |
|
|
|
3917 |
|
|
When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
|
3918 |
|
|
@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
|
3919 |
|
|
contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
|
3920 |
|
|
an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
|
3921 |
|
|
macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
|
3922 |
|
|
never both of them at once.
|
3923 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3924 |
|
|
|
3925 |
|
|
@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
|
3926 |
|
|
Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
|
3927 |
|
|
it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
|
3928 |
|
|
@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
|
3929 |
|
|
is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
|
3930 |
|
|
0)} is used instead.
|
3931 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3932 |
|
|
|
3933 |
|
|
@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
|
3934 |
|
|
Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
|
3935 |
|
|
finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
|
3936 |
|
|
undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
|
3937 |
|
|
|
3938 |
|
|
The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
|
3939 |
|
|
with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
|
3940 |
|
|
argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
|
3941 |
|
|
@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
|
3942 |
|
|
@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
|
3943 |
|
|
@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
|
3944 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3945 |
|
|
|
3946 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
3947 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
|
3948 |
|
|
@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
|
3949 |
|
|
values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
|
3950 |
|
|
Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
|
3951 |
|
|
the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
|
3952 |
|
|
|
3953 |
|
|
This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
|
3954 |
|
|
on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
|
3955 |
|
|
used for arguments without any special help.
|
3956 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3957 |
|
|
|
3958 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
|
3959 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
|
3960 |
|
|
to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
|
3961 |
|
|
@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
|
3962 |
|
|
@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
|
3963 |
|
|
|
3964 |
|
|
The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
|
3965 |
|
|
multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
|
3966 |
|
|
it.
|
3967 |
|
|
|
3968 |
|
|
This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
|
3969 |
|
|
For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
|
3970 |
|
|
big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
|
3971 |
|
|
constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
|
3972 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3973 |
|
|
|
3974 |
|
|
@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
|
3975 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
|
3976 |
|
|
implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
|
3977 |
|
|
next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
|
3978 |
|
|
controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
|
3979 |
|
|
arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
|
3980 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3981 |
|
|
|
3982 |
|
|
@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
|
3983 |
|
|
Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
|
3984 |
|
|
memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
|
3985 |
|
|
macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
|
3986 |
|
|
machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
|
3987 |
|
|
@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
|
3988 |
|
|
registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
|
3989 |
|
|
a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
|
3990 |
|
|
required.
|
3991 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3992 |
|
|
|
3993 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
|
3994 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
|
3995 |
|
|
of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
|
3996 |
|
|
@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
|
3997 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
3998 |
|
|
|
3999 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
|
4000 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
|
4001 |
|
|
register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
|
4002 |
|
|
@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
|
4003 |
|
|
the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
|
4004 |
|
|
used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
|
4005 |
|
|
stack.
|
4006 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4007 |
|
|
|
4008 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (tree @var{type})
|
4009 |
|
|
This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
|
4010 |
|
|
as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
|
4011 |
|
|
arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
|
4012 |
|
|
to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
|
4013 |
|
|
AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
|
4014 |
|
|
registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
|
4015 |
|
|
point register.
|
4016 |
|
|
|
4017 |
|
|
The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
|
4018 |
|
|
false.
|
4019 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4020 |
|
|
|
4021 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
|
4022 |
|
|
This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
|
4023 |
|
|
The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
|
4024 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4025 |
|
|
|
4026 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, tree *@var{pre_p}, tree *@var{post_p})
|
4027 |
|
|
This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
|
4028 |
|
|
@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
|
4029 |
|
|
arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
|
4030 |
|
|
@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
|
4031 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4032 |
|
|
|
4033 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
|
4034 |
|
|
Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
|
4035 |
|
|
with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
|
4036 |
|
|
hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
|
4037 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4038 |
|
|
|
4039 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
|
4040 |
|
|
Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
|
4041 |
|
|
insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
|
4042 |
|
|
considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
|
4043 |
|
|
must work.
|
4044 |
|
|
|
4045 |
|
|
The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
|
4046 |
|
|
required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
|
4047 |
|
|
Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
|
4048 |
|
|
code in @file{optabs.c}.
|
4049 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4050 |
|
|
|
4051 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
|
4052 |
|
|
Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
|
4053 |
|
|
insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
|
4054 |
|
|
must have move patterns for this mode.
|
4055 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4056 |
|
|
|
4057 |
|
|
@node Scalar Return
|
4058 |
|
|
@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
|
4059 |
|
|
@cindex return values in registers
|
4060 |
|
|
@cindex values, returned by functions
|
4061 |
|
|
@cindex scalars, returned as values
|
4062 |
|
|
|
4063 |
|
|
This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
|
4064 |
|
|
values---values that can fit in registers.
|
4065 |
|
|
|
4066 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (tree @var{ret_type}, tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
|
4067 |
|
|
|
4068 |
|
|
Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
|
4069 |
|
|
returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
|
4070 |
|
|
node representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
|
4071 |
|
|
representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
|
4072 |
|
|
function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
|
4073 |
|
|
compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
|
4074 |
|
|
Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
|
4075 |
|
|
a function returns a value.
|
4076 |
|
|
|
4077 |
|
|
On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
|
4078 |
|
|
(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
|
4079 |
|
|
place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
|
4080 |
|
|
@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
|
4081 |
|
|
The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
|
4082 |
|
|
multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
|
4083 |
|
|
@code{parallel} form.
|
4084 |
|
|
|
4085 |
|
|
If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
|
4086 |
|
|
the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
|
4087 |
|
|
@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
|
4088 |
|
|
|
4089 |
|
|
If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
|
4090 |
|
|
node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
|
4091 |
|
|
pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
|
4092 |
|
|
convention for specific functions when all their calls are
|
4093 |
|
|
known.
|
4094 |
|
|
|
4095 |
|
|
Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
|
4096 |
|
|
which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
|
4097 |
|
|
the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
|
4098 |
|
|
different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
|
4099 |
|
|
|
4100 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
|
4101 |
|
|
aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
|
4102 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
|
4103 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4104 |
|
|
|
4105 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
|
4106 |
|
|
This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
|
4107 |
|
|
a new target instead.
|
4108 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4109 |
|
|
|
4110 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
|
4111 |
|
|
This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
|
4112 |
|
|
a new target instead.
|
4113 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4114 |
|
|
|
4115 |
|
|
@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
|
4116 |
|
|
A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
|
4117 |
|
|
function returns a value of mode @var{mode}. If the precise function
|
4118 |
|
|
being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
|
4119 |
|
|
(@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
|
4120 |
|
|
pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
|
4121 |
|
|
convention for specific functions when all their calls are
|
4122 |
|
|
known.
|
4123 |
|
|
|
4124 |
|
|
Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
|
4125 |
|
|
support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
|
4126 |
|
|
specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
|
4127 |
|
|
compiled.
|
4128 |
|
|
|
4129 |
|
|
The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
|
4130 |
|
|
data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
|
4131 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4132 |
|
|
|
4133 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
|
4134 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
|
4135 |
|
|
register in which the values of called function may come back.
|
4136 |
|
|
|
4137 |
|
|
A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
|
4138 |
|
|
second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
|
4139 |
|
|
recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
|
4140 |
|
|
suffices:
|
4141 |
|
|
|
4142 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
4143 |
|
|
#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
|
4144 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
4145 |
|
|
|
4146 |
|
|
If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
|
4147 |
|
|
function use different registers for the return value, this macro
|
4148 |
|
|
should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
|
4149 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4150 |
|
|
|
4151 |
|
|
@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
|
4152 |
|
|
Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
|
4153 |
|
|
need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
|
4154 |
|
|
saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
|
4155 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4156 |
|
|
|
4157 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (tree @var{type})
|
4158 |
|
|
This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
|
4159 |
|
|
at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
|
4160 |
|
|
padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
|
4161 |
|
|
is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
|
4162 |
|
|
|
4163 |
|
|
Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
|
4164 |
|
|
be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
|
4165 |
|
|
or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
|
4166 |
|
|
4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
|
4167 |
|
|
@code{SImode} rtx.
|
4168 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4169 |
|
|
|
4170 |
|
|
@node Aggregate Return
|
4171 |
|
|
@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
|
4172 |
|
|
@cindex aggregates as return values
|
4173 |
|
|
@cindex large return values
|
4174 |
|
|
@cindex returning aggregate values
|
4175 |
|
|
@cindex structure value address
|
4176 |
|
|
|
4177 |
|
|
When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
|
4178 |
|
|
cases), the value is not returned according to
|
4179 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
|
4180 |
|
|
caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
|
4181 |
|
|
should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
|
4182 |
|
|
address}.
|
4183 |
|
|
|
4184 |
|
|
This section describes how to control returning structure values in
|
4185 |
|
|
memory.
|
4186 |
|
|
|
4187 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (tree @var{type}, tree @var{fntype})
|
4188 |
|
|
This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
|
4189 |
|
|
function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
|
4190 |
|
|
Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
|
4191 |
|
|
will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
|
4192 |
|
|
libcalls.
|
4193 |
|
|
|
4194 |
|
|
Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
|
4195 |
|
|
by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
|
4196 |
|
|
takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
|
4197 |
|
|
possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
|
4198 |
|
|
definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
|
4199 |
|
|
values, and 0 otherwise.
|
4200 |
|
|
|
4201 |
|
|
Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
|
4202 |
|
|
be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
|
4203 |
|
|
to indicate this.
|
4204 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4205 |
|
|
|
4206 |
|
|
@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
|
4207 |
|
|
Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
|
4208 |
|
|
in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
|
4209 |
|
|
only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
|
4210 |
|
|
If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
|
4211 |
|
|
and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
|
4212 |
|
|
target hook.
|
4213 |
|
|
|
4214 |
|
|
If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
|
4215 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4216 |
|
|
|
4217 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
|
4218 |
|
|
This target hook should return the location of the structure value
|
4219 |
|
|
address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
|
4220 |
|
|
passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
|
4221 |
|
|
be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
|
4222 |
|
|
hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
|
4223 |
|
|
argument.
|
4224 |
|
|
|
4225 |
|
|
On some architectures the place where the structure value address
|
4226 |
|
|
is found by the called function is not the same place that the
|
4227 |
|
|
caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
|
4228 |
|
|
be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
|
4229 |
|
|
@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
|
4230 |
|
|
the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
|
4231 |
|
|
the caller.
|
4232 |
|
|
|
4233 |
|
|
If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
|
4234 |
|
|
stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
|
4235 |
|
|
@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
|
4236 |
|
|
structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
|
4237 |
|
|
to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
|
4238 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4239 |
|
|
|
4240 |
|
|
@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
|
4241 |
|
|
Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
|
4242 |
|
|
for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
|
4243 |
|
|
the address of a static variable containing the value.
|
4244 |
|
|
|
4245 |
|
|
Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
|
4246 |
|
|
pass an address to the subroutine.
|
4247 |
|
|
|
4248 |
|
|
This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
|
4249 |
|
|
nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
|
4250 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4251 |
|
|
|
4252 |
|
|
@node Caller Saves
|
4253 |
|
|
@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
|
4254 |
|
|
|
4255 |
|
|
If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
|
4256 |
|
|
makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
|
4257 |
|
|
must live across calls.
|
4258 |
|
|
|
4259 |
|
|
@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
|
4260 |
|
|
A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
|
4261 |
|
|
a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
|
4262 |
|
|
restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
|
4263 |
|
|
this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
|
4264 |
|
|
|
4265 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
|
4266 |
|
|
machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
|
4267 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4268 |
|
|
|
4269 |
|
|
@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
|
4270 |
|
|
A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
|
4271 |
|
|
of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
|
4272 |
|
|
@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
|
4273 |
|
|
returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
|
4274 |
|
|
will select the smallest suitable mode.
|
4275 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4276 |
|
|
|
4277 |
|
|
@node Function Entry
|
4278 |
|
|
@subsection Function Entry and Exit
|
4279 |
|
|
@cindex function entry and exit
|
4280 |
|
|
@cindex prologue
|
4281 |
|
|
@cindex epilogue
|
4282 |
|
|
|
4283 |
|
|
This section describes the macros that output function entry
|
4284 |
|
|
(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
|
4285 |
|
|
|
4286 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
|
4287 |
|
|
If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
|
4288 |
|
|
function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
|
4289 |
|
|
initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
|
4290 |
|
|
saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
|
4291 |
|
|
local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
|
4292 |
|
|
stream to which the assembler code should be output.
|
4293 |
|
|
|
4294 |
|
|
The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
|
4295 |
|
|
macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
|
4296 |
|
|
|
4297 |
|
|
@findex regs_ever_live
|
4298 |
|
|
To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
|
4299 |
|
|
@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
|
4300 |
|
|
@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
|
4301 |
|
|
prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
|
4302 |
|
|
call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
|
4303 |
|
|
@code{regs_ever_live}.)
|
4304 |
|
|
|
4305 |
|
|
On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
|
4306 |
|
|
not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
|
4307 |
|
|
they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
|
4308 |
|
|
appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
|
4309 |
|
|
registers are used in the function.
|
4310 |
|
|
|
4311 |
|
|
@findex frame_pointer_needed
|
4312 |
|
|
On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
|
4313 |
|
|
function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
|
4314 |
|
|
pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
|
4315 |
|
|
frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
|
4316 |
|
|
@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
|
4317 |
|
|
time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
|
4318 |
|
|
|
4319 |
|
|
The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
|
4320 |
|
|
required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
|
4321 |
|
|
listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
|
4322 |
|
|
order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
|
4323 |
|
|
stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
|
4324 |
|
|
the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
|
4325 |
|
|
for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
|
4326 |
|
|
compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
|
4327 |
|
|
or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
|
4328 |
|
|
need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
|
4329 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4330 |
|
|
|
4331 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
|
4332 |
|
|
If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
|
4333 |
|
|
prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
|
4334 |
|
|
emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
|
4335 |
|
|
emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
|
4336 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4337 |
|
|
|
4338 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
|
4339 |
|
|
If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
|
4340 |
|
|
epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
|
4341 |
|
|
emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
|
4342 |
|
|
emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
|
4343 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4344 |
|
|
|
4345 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
|
4346 |
|
|
If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
|
4347 |
|
|
function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
|
4348 |
|
|
registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
|
4349 |
|
|
called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
|
4350 |
|
|
same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
|
4351 |
|
|
registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
|
4352 |
|
|
@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
|
4353 |
|
|
|
4354 |
|
|
On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
|
4355 |
|
|
of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
|
4356 |
|
|
instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
|
4357 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
|
4358 |
|
|
|
4359 |
|
|
Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
|
4360 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
|
4361 |
|
|
switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
|
4362 |
|
|
define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
|
4363 |
|
|
target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
|
4364 |
|
|
condition is false, epilogues will be used.
|
4365 |
|
|
|
4366 |
|
|
On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
|
4367 |
|
|
function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
|
4368 |
|
|
two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
|
4369 |
|
|
is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
|
4370 |
|
|
@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
|
4371 |
|
|
a function that needs a frame pointer.
|
4372 |
|
|
|
4373 |
|
|
Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
|
4374 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
|
4375 |
|
|
The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
|
4376 |
|
|
function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
|
4377 |
|
|
|
4378 |
|
|
On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
|
4379 |
|
|
others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
|
4380 |
|
|
given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
|
4381 |
|
|
number of arguments.
|
4382 |
|
|
|
4383 |
|
|
@findex current_function_pops_args
|
4384 |
|
|
Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
|
4385 |
|
|
functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
|
4386 |
|
|
needs to know what was decided. The variable that is called
|
4387 |
|
|
@code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
|
4388 |
|
|
arguments that a function should pop. @xref{Scalar Return}.
|
4389 |
|
|
@c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
|
4390 |
|
|
@c tell? --mew 5feb93
|
4391 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4392 |
|
|
|
4393 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
4394 |
|
|
@item
|
4395 |
|
|
@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
|
4396 |
|
|
A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
|
4397 |
|
|
uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
|
4398 |
|
|
stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
|
4399 |
|
|
if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
|
4400 |
|
|
arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
|
4401 |
|
|
yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
|
4402 |
|
|
region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
|
4403 |
|
|
registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
|
4404 |
|
|
features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
|
4405 |
|
|
|
4406 |
|
|
@item
|
4407 |
|
|
An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
|
4408 |
|
|
The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
|
4409 |
|
|
the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
|
4410 |
|
|
machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
|
4411 |
|
|
in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
|
4412 |
|
|
a save area.
|
4413 |
|
|
|
4414 |
|
|
@item
|
4415 |
|
|
A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
|
4416 |
|
|
boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
|
4417 |
|
|
this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
|
4418 |
|
|
save area closer to the top of the stack.
|
4419 |
|
|
|
4420 |
|
|
@item
|
4421 |
|
|
@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
|
4422 |
|
|
Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
|
4423 |
|
|
@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
|
4424 |
|
|
argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
|
4425 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
4426 |
|
|
|
4427 |
|
|
@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
|
4428 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
|
4429 |
|
|
instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
|
4430 |
|
|
pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
|
4431 |
|
|
adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
|
4432 |
|
|
default is 0.
|
4433 |
|
|
|
4434 |
|
|
Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
|
4435 |
|
|
frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
|
4436 |
|
|
stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
|
4437 |
|
|
compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
|
4438 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4439 |
|
|
|
4440 |
|
|
@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
|
4441 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
|
4442 |
|
|
used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
|
4443 |
|
|
pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
|
4444 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4445 |
|
|
|
4446 |
|
|
@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
|
4447 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
|
4448 |
|
|
used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
|
4449 |
|
|
on entry to an exception edge.
|
4450 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4451 |
|
|
|
4452 |
|
|
@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
|
4453 |
|
|
Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
|
4454 |
|
|
instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
|
4455 |
|
|
definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
|
4456 |
|
|
representing the number of delay slots there.
|
4457 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4458 |
|
|
|
4459 |
|
|
@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
|
4460 |
|
|
A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
|
4461 |
|
|
slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
|
4462 |
|
|
|
4463 |
|
|
The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
|
4464 |
|
|
being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
|
4465 |
|
|
eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
|
4466 |
|
|
of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
|
4467 |
|
|
If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
|
4468 |
|
|
may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
|
4469 |
|
|
(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
|
4470 |
|
|
slot.
|
4471 |
|
|
|
4472 |
|
|
@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
|
4473 |
|
|
@findex final_scan_insn
|
4474 |
|
|
The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
|
4475 |
|
|
list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
|
4476 |
|
|
@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
|
4477 |
|
|
delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
|
4478 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
|
4479 |
|
|
outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
|
4480 |
|
|
@code{final_scan_insn}.
|
4481 |
|
|
|
4482 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if you did not define
|
4483 |
|
|
@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
|
4484 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4485 |
|
|
|
4486 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
|
4487 |
|
|
A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
|
4488 |
|
|
function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
|
4489 |
|
|
inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
|
4490 |
|
|
adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
|
4491 |
|
|
the real function.
|
4492 |
|
|
|
4493 |
|
|
First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
|
4494 |
|
|
contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
|
4495 |
|
|
contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
|
4496 |
|
|
in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
|
4497 |
|
|
e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
|
4498 |
|
|
all other incoming arguments.
|
4499 |
|
|
|
4500 |
|
|
Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
|
4501 |
|
|
made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
|
4502 |
|
|
adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
|
4503 |
|
|
|
4504 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
4505 |
|
|
p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
|
4506 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
4507 |
|
|
|
4508 |
|
|
After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
|
4509 |
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
|
4510 |
|
|
not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
|
4511 |
|
|
return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
|
4512 |
|
|
|
4513 |
|
|
The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
|
4514 |
|
|
the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
|
4515 |
|
|
of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
|
4516 |
|
|
and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
|
4517 |
|
|
|
4518 |
|
|
The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
|
4519 |
|
|
have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
|
4520 |
|
|
some targets, but probably not.
|
4521 |
|
|
|
4522 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
|
4523 |
|
|
front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
|
4524 |
|
|
@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
|
4525 |
|
|
not support varargs.
|
4526 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4527 |
|
|
|
4528 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
|
4529 |
|
|
A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
|
4530 |
|
|
to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
|
4531 |
|
|
arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
|
4532 |
|
|
generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
|
4533 |
|
|
previously exposed.
|
4534 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4535 |
|
|
|
4536 |
|
|
@node Profiling
|
4537 |
|
|
@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
|
4538 |
|
|
@cindex profiling, code generation
|
4539 |
|
|
|
4540 |
|
|
These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
|
4541 |
|
|
|
4542 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
|
4543 |
|
|
A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
|
4544 |
|
|
assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
|
4545 |
|
|
|
4546 |
|
|
@findex mcount
|
4547 |
|
|
The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
|
4548 |
|
|
your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
|
4549 |
|
|
compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
|
4550 |
|
|
compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
|
4551 |
|
|
|
4552 |
|
|
Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
|
4553 |
|
|
variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
|
4554 |
|
|
@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
|
4555 |
|
|
the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
|
4556 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4557 |
|
|
|
4558 |
|
|
@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
|
4559 |
|
|
A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
|
4560 |
|
|
code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
|
4561 |
|
|
not support profiling.
|
4562 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4563 |
|
|
|
4564 |
|
|
@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
|
4565 |
|
|
Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
|
4566 |
|
|
@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
|
4567 |
|
|
allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
|
4568 |
|
|
implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
|
4569 |
|
|
@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
|
4570 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4571 |
|
|
|
4572 |
|
|
@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
|
4573 |
|
|
Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
|
4574 |
|
|
the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
|
4575 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4576 |
|
|
|
4577 |
|
|
@node Tail Calls
|
4578 |
|
|
@subsection Permitting tail calls
|
4579 |
|
|
@cindex tail calls
|
4580 |
|
|
|
4581 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
|
4582 |
|
|
True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
|
4583 |
|
|
call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
|
4584 |
|
|
or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
|
4585 |
|
|
|
4586 |
|
|
It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
|
4587 |
|
|
tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
|
4588 |
|
|
during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
|
4589 |
|
|
as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
|
4590 |
|
|
``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
|
4591 |
|
|
may vary greatly between different architectures.
|
4592 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4593 |
|
|
|
4594 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap *@var{regs})
|
4595 |
|
|
Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
|
4596 |
|
|
function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
|
4597 |
|
|
cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
|
4598 |
|
|
registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
|
4599 |
|
|
TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
|
4600 |
|
|
FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
|
4601 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4602 |
|
|
|
4603 |
|
|
@node Stack Smashing Protection
|
4604 |
|
|
@subsection Stack smashing protection
|
4605 |
|
|
@cindex stack smashing protection
|
4606 |
|
|
|
4607 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
|
4608 |
|
|
This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
|
4609 |
|
|
for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
|
4610 |
|
|
runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
|
4611 |
|
|
that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
|
4612 |
|
|
variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
|
4613 |
|
|
|
4614 |
|
|
The default version of this hook creates a variable called
|
4615 |
|
|
@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
|
4616 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4617 |
|
|
|
4618 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
|
4619 |
|
|
This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
|
4620 |
|
|
stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
|
4621 |
|
|
involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
|
4622 |
|
|
|
4623 |
|
|
The default version of this hook invokes a function called
|
4624 |
|
|
@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
|
4625 |
|
|
normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
|
4626 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4627 |
|
|
|
4628 |
|
|
@node Varargs
|
4629 |
|
|
@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
|
4630 |
|
|
@cindex varargs implementation
|
4631 |
|
|
|
4632 |
|
|
GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
|
4633 |
|
|
@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
|
4634 |
|
|
on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
|
4635 |
|
|
varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
|
4636 |
|
|
conditionals to include it.
|
4637 |
|
|
|
4638 |
|
|
ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
|
4639 |
|
|
the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
|
4640 |
|
|
implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
|
4641 |
|
|
to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
|
4642 |
|
|
@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
|
4643 |
|
|
supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
|
4644 |
|
|
|
4645 |
|
|
However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
|
4646 |
|
|
the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
|
4647 |
|
|
below.
|
4648 |
|
|
|
4649 |
|
|
@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
|
4650 |
|
|
Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
|
4651 |
|
|
that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
|
4652 |
|
|
versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
|
4653 |
|
|
you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
|
4654 |
|
|
|
4655 |
|
|
On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
|
4656 |
|
|
control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
|
4657 |
|
|
other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
|
4658 |
|
|
found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
|
4659 |
|
|
|
4660 |
|
|
Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
|
4661 |
|
|
beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
|
4662 |
|
|
@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
|
4663 |
|
|
This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
|
4664 |
|
|
to use them for its own purposes.
|
4665 |
|
|
@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
|
4666 |
|
|
@c 10feb93
|
4667 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4668 |
|
|
|
4669 |
|
|
@defmac __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
|
4670 |
|
|
Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
|
4671 |
|
|
registers.
|
4672 |
|
|
|
4673 |
|
|
In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
|
4674 |
|
|
arguments, each for a particular category of data types. (For example,
|
4675 |
|
|
on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
|
4676 |
|
|
arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
|
4677 |
|
|
To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
|
4678 |
|
|
have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
|
4679 |
|
|
registers in each category have been used so far
|
4680 |
|
|
|
4681 |
|
|
@code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
|
4682 |
|
|
@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
|
4683 |
|
|
with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access. Thus, the
|
4684 |
|
|
value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
|
4685 |
|
|
|
4686 |
|
|
Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
|
4687 |
|
|
of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
|
4688 |
|
|
value in the @code{va_list} object. This is because @code{va_list} will
|
4689 |
|
|
have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
|
4690 |
|
|
values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
|
4691 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4692 |
|
|
|
4693 |
|
|
@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
|
4694 |
|
|
This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
|
4695 |
|
|
arguments. It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
|
4696 |
|
|
argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
|
4697 |
|
|
returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
|
4698 |
|
|
argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
|
4699 |
|
|
fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
|
4700 |
|
|
verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
|
4701 |
|
|
of the current function.
|
4702 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4703 |
|
|
|
4704 |
|
|
@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
|
4705 |
|
|
Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
|
4706 |
|
|
passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
|
4707 |
|
|
has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
|
4708 |
|
|
specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
|
4709 |
|
|
with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
|
4710 |
|
|
|
4711 |
|
|
@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
|
4712 |
|
|
considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
|
4713 |
|
|
kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
|
4714 |
|
|
|
4715 |
|
|
The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
|
4716 |
|
|
interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
|
4717 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4718 |
|
|
|
4719 |
|
|
These machine description macros help implement varargs:
|
4720 |
|
|
|
4721 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
|
4722 |
|
|
If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
|
4723 |
|
|
@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
|
4724 |
|
|
beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
|
4725 |
|
|
return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
|
4726 |
|
|
to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
|
4727 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4728 |
|
|
|
4729 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
|
4730 |
|
|
This target hook offers an alternative to using
|
4731 |
|
|
@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
|
4732 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
|
4733 |
|
|
register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
|
4734 |
|
|
have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
|
4735 |
|
|
use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
|
4736 |
|
|
pass all their arguments on the stack.
|
4737 |
|
|
|
4738 |
|
|
The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
|
4739 |
|
|
structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
|
4740 |
|
|
named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
|
4741 |
|
|
last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
|
4742 |
|
|
|
4743 |
|
|
The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
|
4744 |
|
|
argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
|
4745 |
|
|
store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
|
4746 |
|
|
variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
|
4747 |
|
|
store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
|
4748 |
|
|
frame.
|
4749 |
|
|
|
4750 |
|
|
Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
|
4751 |
|
|
compile time without knowing their data types,
|
4752 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
|
4753 |
|
|
have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
|
4754 |
|
|
for all data types.
|
4755 |
|
|
|
4756 |
|
|
If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
|
4757 |
|
|
arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
|
4758 |
|
|
happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
|
4759 |
|
|
end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
|
4760 |
|
|
not generate any instructions in this case.
|
4761 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4762 |
|
|
|
4763 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{ca})
|
4764 |
|
|
Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
|
4765 |
|
|
argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
|
4766 |
|
|
|
4767 |
|
|
This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
|
4768 |
|
|
is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
|
4769 |
|
|
@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
|
4770 |
|
|
arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
|
4771 |
|
|
but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
|
4772 |
|
|
then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
|
4773 |
|
|
except the last are treated as named.
|
4774 |
|
|
|
4775 |
|
|
You need not define this hook if it always returns zero.
|
4776 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4777 |
|
|
|
4778 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
|
4779 |
|
|
If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
|
4780 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
|
4781 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
|
4782 |
|
|
defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
|
4783 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
|
4784 |
|
|
Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
|
4785 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4786 |
|
|
|
4787 |
|
|
@node Trampolines
|
4788 |
|
|
@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
|
4789 |
|
|
@cindex trampolines for nested functions
|
4790 |
|
|
@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
|
4791 |
|
|
|
4792 |
|
|
A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
|
4793 |
|
|
when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
|
4794 |
|
|
the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
|
4795 |
|
|
tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
|
4796 |
|
|
trampoline.
|
4797 |
|
|
|
4798 |
|
|
The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
|
4799 |
|
|
address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
|
4800 |
|
|
the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
|
4801 |
|
|
two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
|
4802 |
|
|
exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
|
4803 |
|
|
machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
|
4804 |
|
|
two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
|
4805 |
|
|
operands.
|
4806 |
|
|
|
4807 |
|
|
The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
|
4808 |
|
|
parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
|
4809 |
|
|
immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
|
4810 |
|
|
simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
|
4811 |
|
|
proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
|
4812 |
|
|
may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
|
4813 |
|
|
separately.
|
4814 |
|
|
|
4815 |
|
|
@defmac TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
|
4816 |
|
|
A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
|
4817 |
|
|
block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline. This
|
4818 |
|
|
code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
|
4819 |
|
|
automatically.
|
4820 |
|
|
|
4821 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
|
4822 |
|
|
for the target. Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
|
4823 |
|
|
code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
|
4824 |
|
|
to generate it on the spot.
|
4825 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4826 |
|
|
|
4827 |
|
|
@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
|
4828 |
|
|
Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
|
4829 |
|
|
(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
|
4830 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4831 |
|
|
|
4832 |
|
|
@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
|
4833 |
|
|
A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
|
4834 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4835 |
|
|
|
4836 |
|
|
@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
|
4837 |
|
|
Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
|
4838 |
|
|
|
4839 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
|
4840 |
|
|
is used for aligning trampolines.
|
4841 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4842 |
|
|
|
4843 |
|
|
@defmac INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
|
4844 |
|
|
A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
|
4845 |
|
|
@var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
|
4846 |
|
|
an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
|
4847 |
|
|
RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
|
4848 |
|
|
when it is called.
|
4849 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4850 |
|
|
|
4851 |
|
|
@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
|
4852 |
|
|
A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
|
4853 |
|
|
the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address that
|
4854 |
|
|
was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}. In case the address to be
|
4855 |
|
|
used for a function call should be different from the address in which
|
4856 |
|
|
the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
|
4857 |
|
|
@var{addr}. If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
|
4858 |
|
|
function calls.
|
4859 |
|
|
|
4860 |
|
|
@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
|
4861 |
|
|
@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
|
4862 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
|
4863 |
|
|
a stack slot. This default is right for most machines. The exceptions
|
4864 |
|
|
are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
|
4865 |
|
|
area. On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
|
4866 |
|
|
using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
|
4867 |
|
|
and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
|
4868 |
|
|
|
4869 |
|
|
@var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
|
4870 |
|
|
describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
|
4871 |
|
|
the function which the trampoline is for. The stack slot for the
|
4872 |
|
|
trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function. Other
|
4873 |
|
|
allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
|
4874 |
|
|
information.
|
4875 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4876 |
|
|
|
4877 |
|
|
Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
|
4878 |
|
|
separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
|
4879 |
|
|
fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
|
4880 |
|
|
jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
|
4881 |
|
|
|
4882 |
|
|
Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
|
4883 |
|
|
the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
|
4884 |
|
|
make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
|
4885 |
|
|
subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
|
4886 |
|
|
latter makes initialization faster.
|
4887 |
|
|
|
4888 |
|
|
To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
|
4889 |
|
|
the following macro.
|
4890 |
|
|
|
4891 |
|
|
@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
|
4892 |
|
|
If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
|
4893 |
|
|
cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
|
4894 |
|
|
typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
|
4895 |
|
|
@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
|
4896 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4897 |
|
|
|
4898 |
|
|
The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
|
4899 |
|
|
before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
|
4900 |
|
|
the following macro.
|
4901 |
|
|
|
4902 |
|
|
@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
|
4903 |
|
|
Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
|
4904 |
|
|
code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
|
4905 |
|
|
file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
|
4906 |
|
|
named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
|
4907 |
|
|
emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
|
4908 |
|
|
@code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE} macro.
|
4909 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4910 |
|
|
|
4911 |
|
|
To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
|
4912 |
|
|
you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
|
4913 |
|
|
cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
|
4914 |
|
|
beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
|
4915 |
|
|
its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
|
4916 |
|
|
|
4917 |
|
|
@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
|
4918 |
|
|
Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
|
4919 |
|
|
work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
|
4920 |
|
|
which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
|
4921 |
|
|
@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
|
4922 |
|
|
|
4923 |
|
|
If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
|
4924 |
|
|
C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
|
4925 |
|
|
special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
|
4926 |
|
|
statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
|
4927 |
|
|
global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
|
4928 |
|
|
special assembler code.
|
4929 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4930 |
|
|
|
4931 |
|
|
@node Library Calls
|
4932 |
|
|
@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
|
4933 |
|
|
@cindex library subroutine names
|
4934 |
|
|
@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
|
4935 |
|
|
|
4936 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
4937 |
|
|
Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
|
4938 |
|
|
|
4939 |
|
|
@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
|
4940 |
|
|
This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
|
4941 |
|
|
expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
|
4942 |
|
|
provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
|
4943 |
|
|
are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
|
4944 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4945 |
|
|
|
4946 |
|
|
@findex init_one_libfunc
|
4947 |
|
|
@findex set_optab_libfunc
|
4948 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
|
4949 |
|
|
This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
|
4950 |
|
|
existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
|
4951 |
|
|
@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
|
4952 |
|
|
@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
|
4953 |
|
|
library routines.
|
4954 |
|
|
|
4955 |
|
|
The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
|
4956 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
4957 |
|
|
|
4958 |
|
|
@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
|
4959 |
|
|
This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
|
4960 |
|
|
implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
|
4961 |
|
|
mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
|
4962 |
|
|
return a tristate.
|
4963 |
|
|
|
4964 |
|
|
GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
|
4965 |
|
|
comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
|
4966 |
|
|
don't need to define this macro.
|
4967 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4968 |
|
|
|
4969 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
|
4970 |
|
|
This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
|
4971 |
|
|
functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
|
4972 |
|
|
operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
|
4973 |
|
|
and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
|
4974 |
|
|
If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
|
4975 |
|
|
@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
|
4976 |
|
|
in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
|
4977 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4978 |
|
|
|
4979 |
|
|
@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
|
4980 |
|
|
@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
|
4981 |
|
|
@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
|
4982 |
|
|
@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
|
4983 |
|
|
@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
|
4984 |
|
|
Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
|
4985 |
|
|
library to provide floating point emulation.
|
4986 |
|
|
|
4987 |
|
|
In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
|
4988 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
|
4989 |
|
|
else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
|
4990 |
|
|
in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
|
4991 |
|
|
architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
|
4992 |
|
|
an example.
|
4993 |
|
|
|
4994 |
|
|
If this macro is defined, the
|
4995 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
|
4996 |
|
|
false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
|
4997 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
4998 |
|
|
|
4999 |
|
|
@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
|
5000 |
|
|
@findex matherr
|
5001 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_EDOM
|
5002 |
|
|
The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
|
5003 |
|
|
expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
|
5004 |
|
|
deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
|
5005 |
|
|
@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
|
5006 |
|
|
system.
|
5007 |
|
|
|
5008 |
|
|
If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
|
5009 |
|
|
domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
|
5010 |
|
|
error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
|
5011 |
|
|
there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
|
5012 |
|
|
that @code{matherr} is used normally.
|
5013 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5014 |
|
|
|
5015 |
|
|
@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
|
5016 |
|
|
@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
|
5017 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
|
5018 |
|
|
refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
|
5019 |
|
|
@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
|
5020 |
|
|
macro, a reasonable default is used.
|
5021 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5022 |
|
|
|
5023 |
|
|
@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
|
5024 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
|
5025 |
|
|
When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
|
5026 |
|
|
@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
|
5027 |
|
|
default is nonzero that should be proper value for most modern systems, however
|
5028 |
|
|
number of existing systems lacks support for these functions in the runtime so
|
5029 |
|
|
they needs this macro to be redefined to 0.
|
5030 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5031 |
|
|
|
5032 |
|
|
@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
|
5033 |
|
|
Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
|
5034 |
|
|
the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
|
5035 |
|
|
involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
|
5036 |
|
|
at once to the method-lookup library function.
|
5037 |
|
|
|
5038 |
|
|
The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
|
5039 |
|
|
to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
|
5040 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5041 |
|
|
|
5042 |
|
|
@node Addressing Modes
|
5043 |
|
|
@section Addressing Modes
|
5044 |
|
|
@cindex addressing modes
|
5045 |
|
|
|
5046 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
5047 |
|
|
This is about addressing modes.
|
5048 |
|
|
|
5049 |
|
|
@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
|
5050 |
|
|
@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
|
5051 |
|
|
@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
|
5052 |
|
|
@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
|
5053 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
|
5054 |
|
|
pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
|
5055 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5056 |
|
|
|
5057 |
|
|
@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
|
5058 |
|
|
@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
|
5059 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
|
5060 |
|
|
post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
|
5061 |
|
|
the size of the memory operand.
|
5062 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5063 |
|
|
|
5064 |
|
|
@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
|
5065 |
|
|
@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
|
5066 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
|
5067 |
|
|
post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
|
5068 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5069 |
|
|
|
5070 |
|
|
@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
|
5071 |
|
|
A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
|
5072 |
|
|
is a valid address. On most machines, this can be defined as
|
5073 |
|
|
@code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
|
5074 |
|
|
in which constant addresses are supported.
|
5075 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5076 |
|
|
|
5077 |
|
|
@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
|
5078 |
|
|
@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
|
5079 |
|
|
accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
|
5080 |
|
|
known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
|
5081 |
|
|
expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
|
5082 |
|
|
@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
|
5083 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5084 |
|
|
|
5085 |
|
|
@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
|
5086 |
|
|
A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
|
5087 |
|
|
memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
|
5088 |
|
|
the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
|
5089 |
|
|
accept.
|
5090 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5091 |
|
|
|
5092 |
|
|
@defmac GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
|
5093 |
|
|
A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
|
5094 |
|
|
executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
|
5095 |
|
|
target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
|
5096 |
|
|
|
5097 |
|
|
It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
|
5098 |
|
|
subroutines for this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to
|
5099 |
|
|
understand.
|
5100 |
|
|
|
5101 |
|
|
This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
|
5102 |
|
|
non-strict one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It
|
5103 |
|
|
must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
|
5104 |
|
|
allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference. In
|
5105 |
|
|
contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
|
5106 |
|
|
with no hard register must be rejected.
|
5107 |
|
|
|
5108 |
|
|
The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
|
5109 |
|
|
accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
|
5110 |
|
|
register is required.
|
5111 |
|
|
|
5112 |
|
|
@findex REG_OK_STRICT
|
5113 |
|
|
Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
|
5114 |
|
|
macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
|
5115 |
|
|
@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
|
5116 |
|
|
in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
|
5117 |
|
|
|
5118 |
|
|
Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
|
5119 |
|
|
for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
|
5120 |
|
|
among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
|
5121 |
|
|
Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
|
5122 |
|
|
levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
|
5123 |
|
|
|
5124 |
|
|
Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
|
5125 |
|
|
and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
|
5126 |
|
|
constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
|
5127 |
|
|
specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
|
5128 |
|
|
recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
|
5129 |
|
|
|
5130 |
|
|
Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
|
5131 |
|
|
sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
|
5132 |
|
|
@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
|
5133 |
|
|
naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
|
5134 |
|
|
be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
|
5135 |
|
|
|
5136 |
|
|
@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
|
5137 |
|
|
On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
|
5138 |
|
|
the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
|
5139 |
|
|
target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
|
5140 |
|
|
into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
|
5141 |
|
|
@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
|
5142 |
|
|
@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
|
5143 |
|
|
Format}.
|
5144 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5145 |
|
|
|
5146 |
|
|
@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
|
5147 |
|
|
A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
|
5148 |
|
|
This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
|
5149 |
|
|
|
5150 |
|
|
It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
|
5151 |
|
|
that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
|
5152 |
|
|
|
5153 |
|
|
The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
|
5154 |
|
|
a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
|
5155 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5156 |
|
|
|
5157 |
|
|
@defmac LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
|
5158 |
|
|
A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
|
5159 |
|
|
memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a
|
5160 |
|
|
C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
|
5161 |
|
|
|
5162 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5163 |
|
|
GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
|
5164 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5165 |
|
|
|
5166 |
|
|
@noindent
|
5167 |
|
|
to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
|
5168 |
|
|
|
5169 |
|
|
@findex break_out_memory_refs
|
5170 |
|
|
@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
|
5171 |
|
|
and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
|
5172 |
|
|
@var{x}.
|
5173 |
|
|
|
5174 |
|
|
The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
|
5175 |
|
|
@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
|
5176 |
|
|
should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
|
5177 |
|
|
|
5178 |
|
|
It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
|
5179 |
|
|
address. The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In
|
5180 |
|
|
fact, it is safe to omit this macro. But often a
|
5181 |
|
|
machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
|
5182 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5183 |
|
|
|
5184 |
|
|
@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
|
5185 |
|
|
A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
|
5186 |
|
|
that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
|
5187 |
|
|
@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
|
5188 |
|
|
It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
|
5189 |
|
|
performance reasons.
|
5190 |
|
|
|
5191 |
|
|
For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
|
5192 |
|
|
reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
|
5193 |
|
|
registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
|
5194 |
|
|
processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
|
5195 |
|
|
needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
|
5196 |
|
|
@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
|
5197 |
|
|
generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
|
5198 |
|
|
be shared.
|
5199 |
|
|
|
5200 |
|
|
@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
|
5201 |
|
|
to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
|
5202 |
|
|
and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
|
5203 |
|
|
of reload internals.
|
5204 |
|
|
|
5205 |
|
|
@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
|
5206 |
|
|
previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
|
5207 |
|
|
then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
|
5208 |
|
|
|
5209 |
|
|
@findex push_reload
|
5210 |
|
|
The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
|
5211 |
|
|
need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
|
5212 |
|
|
suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
|
5213 |
|
|
|
5214 |
|
|
The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
|
5215 |
|
|
@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
|
5216 |
|
|
should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
|
5217 |
|
|
This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
|
5218 |
|
|
@code{push_reload}.
|
5219 |
|
|
|
5220 |
|
|
@findex strict_memory_address_p
|
5221 |
|
|
The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
|
5222 |
|
|
the address has become legitimate.
|
5223 |
|
|
|
5224 |
|
|
@findex copy_rtx
|
5225 |
|
|
If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
|
5226 |
|
|
this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that is unshares only a
|
5227 |
|
|
single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
|
5228 |
|
|
top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
|
5229 |
|
|
It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
|
5230 |
|
|
address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
|
5231 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5232 |
|
|
|
5233 |
|
|
@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
|
5234 |
|
|
A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
|
5235 |
|
|
@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
|
5236 |
|
|
different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
|
5237 |
|
|
reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
|
5238 |
|
|
but not others.
|
5239 |
|
|
|
5240 |
|
|
Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
|
5241 |
|
|
effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
|
5242 |
|
|
of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
|
5243 |
|
|
addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
|
5244 |
|
|
|
5245 |
|
|
You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
|
5246 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5247 |
|
|
|
5248 |
|
|
@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
|
5249 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
|
5250 |
|
|
an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
|
5251 |
|
|
@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
|
5252 |
|
|
@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
|
5253 |
|
|
anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
|
5254 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5255 |
|
|
|
5256 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
|
5257 |
|
|
This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
|
5258 |
|
|
@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
|
5259 |
|
|
macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
|
5260 |
|
|
references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
|
5261 |
|
|
addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
|
5262 |
|
|
the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
|
5263 |
|
|
into their original form.
|
5264 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5265 |
|
|
|
5266 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (rtx @var{x})
|
5267 |
|
|
This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
|
5268 |
|
|
should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
|
5269 |
|
|
this hook returns false.
|
5270 |
|
|
|
5271 |
|
|
The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
|
5272 |
|
|
deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
|
5273 |
|
|
from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
|
5274 |
|
|
holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
|
5275 |
|
|
of TLS symbols for various targets.
|
5276 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5277 |
|
|
|
5278 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
|
5279 |
|
|
This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
|
5280 |
|
|
be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
|
5281 |
|
|
of @var{x}.
|
5282 |
|
|
|
5283 |
|
|
The default version returns false for all constants.
|
5284 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5285 |
|
|
|
5286 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
|
5287 |
|
|
This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
|
5288 |
|
|
address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
|
5289 |
|
|
used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
|
5290 |
|
|
@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
|
5291 |
|
|
|
5292 |
|
|
The autovectrizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
|
5293 |
|
|
@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
|
5294 |
|
|
the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
|
5295 |
|
|
@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
|
5296 |
|
|
two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
|
5297 |
|
|
@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
|
5298 |
|
|
the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
|
5299 |
|
|
from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
|
5300 |
|
|
@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
|
5301 |
|
|
@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
|
5302 |
|
|
@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
|
5303 |
|
|
|
5304 |
|
|
If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
|
5305 |
|
|
to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
|
5306 |
|
|
use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
|
5307 |
|
|
@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
|
5308 |
|
|
should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
|
5309 |
|
|
described above.
|
5310 |
|
|
If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
|
5311 |
|
|
the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
|
5312 |
|
|
log2(@var{VS})-1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
|
5313 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5314 |
|
|
|
5315 |
|
|
@node Anchored Addresses
|
5316 |
|
|
@section Anchored Addresses
|
5317 |
|
|
@cindex anchored addresses
|
5318 |
|
|
@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
|
5319 |
|
|
|
5320 |
|
|
GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
|
5321 |
|
|
For example, if we have:
|
5322 |
|
|
|
5323 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5324 |
|
|
static int a, b, c;
|
5325 |
|
|
int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
|
5326 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5327 |
|
|
|
5328 |
|
|
the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
|
5329 |
|
|
addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
|
5330 |
|
|
it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
|
5331 |
|
|
the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
|
5332 |
|
|
be something like:
|
5333 |
|
|
|
5334 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5335 |
|
|
int foo (void)
|
5336 |
|
|
@{
|
5337 |
|
|
register int *xr = &x;
|
5338 |
|
|
return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
|
5339 |
|
|
@}
|
5340 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5341 |
|
|
|
5342 |
|
|
(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
|
5343 |
|
|
``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
|
5344 |
|
|
|
5345 |
|
|
The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
|
5346 |
|
|
in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
|
5347 |
|
|
section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
|
5348 |
|
|
or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
|
5349 |
|
|
|
5350 |
|
|
@deftypevar {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
|
5351 |
|
|
The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
|
5352 |
|
|
On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
|
5353 |
|
|
applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
|
5354 |
|
|
for every mode. The default value is 0.
|
5355 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
5356 |
|
|
|
5357 |
|
|
@deftypevar {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
|
5358 |
|
|
Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
|
5359 |
|
|
offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
|
5360 |
|
|
value is 0.
|
5361 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
5362 |
|
|
|
5363 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
|
5364 |
|
|
Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
|
5365 |
|
|
@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
|
5366 |
|
|
The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
|
5367 |
|
|
of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
|
5368 |
|
|
|
5369 |
|
|
If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
|
5370 |
|
|
it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
|
5371 |
|
|
If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
|
5372 |
|
|
is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
|
5373 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5374 |
|
|
|
5375 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (rtx @var{x})
|
5376 |
|
|
Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
|
5377 |
|
|
@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
|
5378 |
|
|
@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
|
5379 |
|
|
|
5380 |
|
|
The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
|
5381 |
|
|
intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
|
5382 |
|
|
or target-specific sections.
|
5383 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5384 |
|
|
|
5385 |
|
|
@node Condition Code
|
5386 |
|
|
@section Condition Code Status
|
5387 |
|
|
@cindex condition code status
|
5388 |
|
|
|
5389 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
5390 |
|
|
This describes the condition code status.
|
5391 |
|
|
|
5392 |
|
|
@findex cc_status
|
5393 |
|
|
The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
|
5394 |
|
|
describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
|
5395 |
|
|
the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
|
5396 |
|
|
variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
|
5397 |
|
|
currently based, and several standard flags.
|
5398 |
|
|
|
5399 |
|
|
Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
|
5400 |
|
|
description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
|
5401 |
|
|
information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
|
5402 |
|
|
|
5403 |
|
|
@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
|
5404 |
|
|
C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
|
5405 |
|
|
component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
|
5406 |
|
|
|
5407 |
|
|
This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
|
5408 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5409 |
|
|
|
5410 |
|
|
@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
|
5411 |
|
|
A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
|
5412 |
|
|
The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
|
5413 |
|
|
the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
|
5414 |
|
|
define this macro to initialize it.
|
5415 |
|
|
|
5416 |
|
|
This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
|
5417 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5418 |
|
|
|
5419 |
|
|
@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
|
5420 |
|
|
A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
|
5421 |
|
|
appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
|
5422 |
|
|
this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
|
5423 |
|
|
code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
|
5424 |
|
|
set @code{(cc0)}.
|
5425 |
|
|
|
5426 |
|
|
This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
|
5427 |
|
|
|
5428 |
|
|
If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
|
5429 |
|
|
other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
|
5430 |
|
|
invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
|
5431 |
|
|
reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
|
5432 |
|
|
registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
|
5433 |
|
|
@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
|
5434 |
|
|
insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
|
5435 |
|
|
based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
|
5436 |
|
|
value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
|
5437 |
|
|
this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
|
5438 |
|
|
@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
|
5439 |
|
|
@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
|
5440 |
|
|
condition code value.
|
5441 |
|
|
|
5442 |
|
|
The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
|
5443 |
|
|
with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
|
5444 |
|
|
@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
|
5445 |
|
|
constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
|
5446 |
|
|
insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
|
5447 |
|
|
@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
|
5448 |
|
|
@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
|
5449 |
|
|
|
5450 |
|
|
A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
|
5451 |
|
|
that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
|
5452 |
|
|
@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
|
5453 |
|
|
two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
|
5454 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5455 |
|
|
|
5456 |
|
|
@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
|
5457 |
|
|
Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
|
5458 |
|
|
operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}. For
|
5459 |
|
|
example, on the SPARC, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
|
5460 |
|
|
@pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
|
5461 |
|
|
definition)
|
5462 |
|
|
|
5463 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5464 |
|
|
#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
|
5465 |
|
|
(GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
|
5466 |
|
|
? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
|
5467 |
|
|
: ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
|
5468 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
|
5469 |
|
|
? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
|
5470 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5471 |
|
|
|
5472 |
|
|
You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
|
5473 |
|
|
in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
|
5474 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5475 |
|
|
|
5476 |
|
|
@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
|
5477 |
|
|
On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
|
5478 |
|
|
convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
|
5479 |
|
|
does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
|
5480 |
|
|
comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
|
5481 |
|
|
|
5482 |
|
|
On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
|
5483 |
|
|
required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
|
5484 |
|
|
and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
|
5485 |
|
|
comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
|
5486 |
|
|
@var{op1} as required.
|
5487 |
|
|
|
5488 |
|
|
GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
|
5489 |
|
|
valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
|
5490 |
|
|
@file{md} file.
|
5491 |
|
|
|
5492 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
|
5493 |
|
|
code or operands.
|
5494 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5495 |
|
|
|
5496 |
|
|
@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
|
5497 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
|
5498 |
|
|
comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
|
5499 |
|
|
can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
|
5500 |
|
|
then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
|
5501 |
|
|
|
5502 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
|
5503 |
|
|
floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
|
5504 |
|
|
For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
|
5505 |
|
|
inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
|
5506 |
|
|
|
5507 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5508 |
|
|
#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
|
5509 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5510 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5511 |
|
|
|
5512 |
|
|
@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
|
5513 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
|
5514 |
|
|
comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
|
5515 |
|
|
@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
|
5516 |
|
|
machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
|
5517 |
|
|
instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
|
5518 |
|
|
freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
|
5519 |
|
|
like:
|
5520 |
|
|
|
5521 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5522 |
|
|
#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
|
5523 |
|
|
((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
|
5524 |
|
|
: reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
|
5525 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5526 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5527 |
|
|
|
5528 |
|
|
@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
|
5529 |
|
|
A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
|
5530 |
|
|
@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
|
5531 |
|
|
versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
|
5532 |
|
|
predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
|
5533 |
|
|
that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
|
5534 |
|
|
If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
|
5535 |
|
|
|
5536 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
5537 |
|
|
#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
|
5538 |
|
|
(GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
|
5539 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
5540 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5541 |
|
|
|
5542 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *, unsigned int *)
|
5543 |
|
|
On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
|
5544 |
|
|
register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
|
5545 |
|
|
regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
|
5546 |
|
|
hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
|
5547 |
|
|
small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
|
5548 |
|
|
to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
|
5549 |
|
|
arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
|
5550 |
|
|
When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
|
5551 |
|
|
integer pointed to by the second argument should be set to
|
5552 |
|
|
@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
|
5553 |
|
|
|
5554 |
|
|
The default version of this hook returns false.
|
5555 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5556 |
|
|
|
5557 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} enum machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode, enum machine_mode)
|
5558 |
|
|
On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
|
5559 |
|
|
@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
|
5560 |
|
|
validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
|
5561 |
|
|
target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
|
5562 |
|
|
both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
|
5563 |
|
|
return @code{VOIDmode}.
|
5564 |
|
|
|
5565 |
|
|
The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
|
5566 |
|
|
same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
|
5567 |
|
|
returns @code{VOIDmode}.
|
5568 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5569 |
|
|
|
5570 |
|
|
@node Costs
|
5571 |
|
|
@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
|
5572 |
|
|
@cindex costs of instructions
|
5573 |
|
|
@cindex relative costs
|
5574 |
|
|
@cindex speed of instructions
|
5575 |
|
|
|
5576 |
|
|
These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
|
5577 |
|
|
on the target machine.
|
5578 |
|
|
|
5579 |
|
|
@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
|
5580 |
|
|
A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
|
5581 |
|
|
register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
|
5582 |
|
|
expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
|
5583 |
|
|
value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
|
5584 |
|
|
that.
|
5585 |
|
|
|
5586 |
|
|
It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
|
5587 |
|
|
same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
|
5588 |
|
|
registers if they are not general registers.
|
5589 |
|
|
|
5590 |
|
|
If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
|
5591 |
|
|
hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
|
5592 |
|
|
classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
|
5593 |
|
|
constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
|
5594 |
|
|
allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
|
5595 |
|
|
if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
|
5596 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5597 |
|
|
|
5598 |
|
|
@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
|
5599 |
|
|
A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
|
5600 |
|
|
register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
|
5601 |
|
|
is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
|
5602 |
|
|
is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
|
5603 |
|
|
registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
|
5604 |
|
|
should define this macro to express the relative cost.
|
5605 |
|
|
|
5606 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
|
5607 |
|
|
the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
|
5608 |
|
|
needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
|
5609 |
|
|
between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
|
5610 |
|
|
more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
|
5611 |
|
|
reflect the actual cost of the move.
|
5612 |
|
|
|
5613 |
|
|
GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
|
5614 |
|
|
secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
|
5615 |
|
|
a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
|
5616 |
|
|
secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
|
5617 |
|
|
4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
|
5618 |
|
|
value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
|
5619 |
|
|
are the same as to this macro.
|
5620 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5621 |
|
|
|
5622 |
|
|
@defmac BRANCH_COST
|
5623 |
|
|
A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
|
5624 |
|
|
the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
|
5625 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5626 |
|
|
|
5627 |
|
|
Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
|
5628 |
|
|
but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
|
5629 |
|
|
ordinarily expect.
|
5630 |
|
|
|
5631 |
|
|
@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
|
5632 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
|
5633 |
|
|
than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
|
5634 |
|
|
faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
|
5635 |
|
|
require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
|
5636 |
|
|
between byte and (aligned) word loads.
|
5637 |
|
|
|
5638 |
|
|
When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
|
5639 |
|
|
finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
|
5640 |
|
|
load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
|
5641 |
|
|
faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
|
5642 |
|
|
may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
|
5643 |
|
|
other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
|
5644 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5645 |
|
|
|
5646 |
|
|
@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
|
5647 |
|
|
Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
|
5648 |
|
|
@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
|
5649 |
|
|
than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
|
5650 |
|
|
handler.
|
5651 |
|
|
|
5652 |
|
|
When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
|
5653 |
|
|
@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
|
5654 |
|
|
moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
|
5655 |
|
|
Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
|
5656 |
|
|
cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
|
5657 |
|
|
|
5658 |
|
|
If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
|
5659 |
|
|
this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
|
5660 |
|
|
@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
|
5661 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5662 |
|
|
|
5663 |
|
|
@defmac MOVE_RATIO
|
5664 |
|
|
The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
|
5665 |
|
|
which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
|
5666 |
|
|
string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
|
5667 |
|
|
make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
|
5668 |
|
|
|
5669 |
|
|
Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
|
5670 |
|
|
@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
|
5671 |
|
|
the number of such sequences.
|
5672 |
|
|
|
5673 |
|
|
If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
|
5674 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5675 |
|
|
|
5676 |
|
|
@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
5677 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
|
5678 |
|
|
copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
|
5679 |
|
|
will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
|
5680 |
|
|
than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
|
5681 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5682 |
|
|
|
5683 |
|
|
@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
|
5684 |
|
|
A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
|
5685 |
|
|
a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
|
5686 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5687 |
|
|
|
5688 |
|
|
@defmac CLEAR_RATIO
|
5689 |
|
|
The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
|
5690 |
|
|
of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
|
5691 |
|
|
or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
|
5692 |
|
|
eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
|
5693 |
|
|
|
5694 |
|
|
If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
|
5695 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5696 |
|
|
|
5697 |
|
|
@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
5698 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
|
5699 |
|
|
to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
|
5700 |
|
|
will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
|
5701 |
|
|
than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
|
5702 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5703 |
|
|
|
5704 |
|
|
@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
5705 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
|
5706 |
|
|
used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some other
|
5707 |
|
|
mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when storing
|
5708 |
|
|
values other than constant zero and by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
|
5709 |
|
|
when called with a constant source string.
|
5710 |
|
|
Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
|
5711 |
|
|
than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
|
5712 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5713 |
|
|
|
5714 |
|
|
@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
|
5715 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
|
5716 |
|
|
thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
|
5717 |
|
|
@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
|
5718 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5719 |
|
|
|
5720 |
|
|
@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
|
5721 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
|
5722 |
|
|
thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
|
5723 |
|
|
@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
|
5724 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5725 |
|
|
|
5726 |
|
|
@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
|
5727 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
|
5728 |
|
|
thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
|
5729 |
|
|
@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
|
5730 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5731 |
|
|
|
5732 |
|
|
@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
|
5733 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
|
5734 |
|
|
thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
|
5735 |
|
|
@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
|
5736 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5737 |
|
|
|
5738 |
|
|
@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
|
5739 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
|
5740 |
|
|
thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
|
5741 |
|
|
@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
|
5742 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5743 |
|
|
|
5744 |
|
|
@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
|
5745 |
|
|
A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
|
5746 |
|
|
thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
|
5747 |
|
|
@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
|
5748 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5749 |
|
|
|
5750 |
|
|
@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
|
5751 |
|
|
This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
|
5752 |
|
|
thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
|
5753 |
|
|
@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
|
5754 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5755 |
|
|
|
5756 |
|
|
@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
|
5757 |
|
|
This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
|
5758 |
|
|
thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
|
5759 |
|
|
@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
|
5760 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5761 |
|
|
|
5762 |
|
|
@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
|
5763 |
|
|
Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
|
5764 |
|
|
function address than to call an address kept in a register.
|
5765 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5766 |
|
|
|
5767 |
|
|
@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
|
5768 |
|
|
Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
|
5769 |
|
|
@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
|
5770 |
|
|
@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
|
5771 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
5772 |
|
|
|
5773 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int *@var{total})
|
5774 |
|
|
This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
|
5775 |
|
|
|
5776 |
|
|
The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
|
5777 |
|
|
available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
|
5778 |
|
|
in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
|
5779 |
|
|
expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
|
5780 |
|
|
@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
|
5781 |
|
|
|
5782 |
|
|
In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
|
5783 |
|
|
@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
|
5784 |
|
|
instructions.
|
5785 |
|
|
|
5786 |
|
|
On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
|
5787 |
|
|
for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
|
5788 |
|
|
necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
|
5789 |
|
|
for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
|
5790 |
|
|
operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
|
5791 |
|
|
|
5792 |
|
|
When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{optimize_size} is
|
5793 |
|
|
nonzero, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
|
5794 |
|
|
size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
|
5795 |
|
|
|
5796 |
|
|
The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
|
5797 |
|
|
processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
|
5798 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5799 |
|
|
|
5800 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address})
|
5801 |
|
|
This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
|
5802 |
|
|
@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
|
5803 |
|
|
the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
|
5804 |
|
|
|
5805 |
|
|
For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
|
5806 |
|
|
true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
|
5807 |
|
|
instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
|
5808 |
|
|
all addresses will have equal costs.
|
5809 |
|
|
|
5810 |
|
|
In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
|
5811 |
|
|
the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
|
5812 |
|
|
cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
|
5813 |
|
|
|
5814 |
|
|
For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
|
5815 |
|
|
and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
|
5816 |
|
|
is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
|
5817 |
|
|
references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
|
5818 |
|
|
the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
|
5819 |
|
|
that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
|
5820 |
|
|
instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
|
5821 |
|
|
specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
|
5822 |
|
|
|
5823 |
|
|
This hook is never called with an invalid address.
|
5824 |
|
|
|
5825 |
|
|
On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
|
5826 |
|
|
cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
|
5827 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
|
5828 |
|
|
be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
|
5829 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
|
5830 |
|
|
should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
|
5831 |
|
|
should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
|
5832 |
|
|
registers on machines with lots of registers.
|
5833 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5834 |
|
|
|
5835 |
|
|
@node Scheduling
|
5836 |
|
|
@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
|
5837 |
|
|
|
5838 |
|
|
The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
|
5839 |
|
|
adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
|
5840 |
|
|
hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
|
5841 |
|
|
them: try the first ones in this list first.
|
5842 |
|
|
|
5843 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
|
5844 |
|
|
This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
|
5845 |
|
|
issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
|
5846 |
|
|
Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
|
5847 |
|
|
an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
|
5848 |
|
|
constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
|
5849 |
|
|
hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
|
5850 |
|
|
This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
|
5851 |
|
|
it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
|
5852 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
|
5853 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5854 |
|
|
|
5855 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
|
5856 |
|
|
This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
|
5857 |
|
|
from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
|
5858 |
|
|
still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
|
5859 |
|
|
@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
|
5860 |
|
|
@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
|
5861 |
|
|
You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
|
5862 |
|
|
than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
|
5863 |
|
|
@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
|
5864 |
|
|
debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
|
5865 |
|
|
@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
|
5866 |
|
|
was scheduled.
|
5867 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5868 |
|
|
|
5869 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
|
5870 |
|
|
This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
|
5871 |
|
|
relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
|
5872 |
|
|
dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
|
5873 |
|
|
is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
|
5874 |
|
|
to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
|
5875 |
|
|
that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
|
5876 |
|
|
data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
|
5877 |
|
|
description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
|
5878 |
|
|
output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
|
5879 |
|
|
times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
|
5880 |
|
|
acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
|
5881 |
|
|
@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
|
5882 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5883 |
|
|
|
5884 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
|
5885 |
|
|
This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
|
5886 |
|
|
@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
|
5887 |
|
|
execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
|
5888 |
|
|
later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
|
5889 |
|
|
scheduling priorities of insns.
|
5890 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5891 |
|
|
|
5892 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
|
5893 |
|
|
This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
|
5894 |
|
|
list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
|
5895 |
|
|
combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
|
5896 |
|
|
@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
|
5897 |
|
|
debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
|
5898 |
|
|
@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
|
5899 |
|
|
list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
|
5900 |
|
|
a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
|
5901 |
|
|
reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
|
5902 |
|
|
@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
|
5903 |
|
|
is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
|
5904 |
|
|
the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
|
5905 |
|
|
can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
|
5906 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
|
5907 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5908 |
|
|
|
5909 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_ready}, @var{clock})
|
5910 |
|
|
Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
|
5911 |
|
|
function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
|
5912 |
|
|
is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
|
5913 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
|
5914 |
|
|
return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
|
5915 |
|
|
this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
|
5916 |
|
|
scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
|
5917 |
|
|
cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
|
5918 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5919 |
|
|
|
5920 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
|
5921 |
|
|
This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
|
5922 |
|
|
chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
|
5923 |
|
|
correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
|
5924 |
|
|
example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
|
5925 |
|
|
analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
|
5926 |
|
|
dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
|
5927 |
|
|
calculated.
|
5928 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5929 |
|
|
|
5930 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
|
5931 |
|
|
This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
|
5932 |
|
|
instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
|
5933 |
|
|
pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
|
5934 |
|
|
is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
|
5935 |
|
|
@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
|
5936 |
|
|
region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
|
5937 |
|
|
scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
|
5938 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5939 |
|
|
|
5940 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
|
5941 |
|
|
This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
|
5942 |
|
|
instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
|
5943 |
|
|
cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
|
5944 |
|
|
is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
|
5945 |
|
|
to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
|
5946 |
|
|
@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
|
5947 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5948 |
|
|
|
5949 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
|
5950 |
|
|
This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
|
5951 |
|
|
@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
|
5952 |
|
|
@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
|
5953 |
|
|
@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
|
5954 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5955 |
|
|
|
5956 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
|
5957 |
|
|
This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
|
5958 |
|
|
@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
|
5959 |
|
|
@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
|
5960 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5961 |
|
|
|
5962 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
|
5963 |
|
|
The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
|
5964 |
|
|
pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
|
5965 |
|
|
when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
|
5966 |
|
|
simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
|
5967 |
|
|
processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
|
5968 |
|
|
based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
|
5969 |
|
|
when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
|
5970 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5971 |
|
|
|
5972 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
|
5973 |
|
|
The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
|
5974 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5975 |
|
|
|
5976 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
|
5977 |
|
|
The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
|
5978 |
|
|
to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
|
5979 |
|
|
simulated processor cycle finishes.
|
5980 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5981 |
|
|
|
5982 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
|
5983 |
|
|
The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
|
5984 |
|
|
used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
|
5985 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
5986 |
|
|
|
5987 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
|
5988 |
|
|
This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
|
5989 |
|
|
for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
|
5990 |
|
|
chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
|
5991 |
|
|
value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
|
5992 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
|
5993 |
|
|
subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
|
5994 |
|
|
maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
|
5995 |
|
|
@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
|
5996 |
|
|
packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
|
5997 |
|
|
rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
|
5998 |
|
|
|
5999 |
|
|
This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
|
6000 |
|
|
processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
|
6001 |
|
|
with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
|
6002 |
|
|
@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
|
6003 |
|
|
@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
|
6004 |
|
|
processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
|
6005 |
|
|
@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
|
6006 |
|
|
until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
|
6007 |
|
|
the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
|
6008 |
|
|
|
6009 |
|
|
Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
|
6010 |
|
|
pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
|
6011 |
|
|
schedules to choose the best one.
|
6012 |
|
|
|
6013 |
|
|
The default is no multipass scheduling.
|
6014 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6015 |
|
|
|
6016 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx)
|
6017 |
|
|
|
6018 |
|
|
This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
|
6019 |
|
|
considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
|
6020 |
|
|
zero for insn passed as the parameter, the insn will be not chosen to
|
6021 |
|
|
be issued.
|
6022 |
|
|
|
6023 |
|
|
The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
|
6024 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6025 |
|
|
|
6026 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *, int, rtx, int, int, int *)
|
6027 |
|
|
|
6028 |
|
|
This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing insn passed
|
6029 |
|
|
as the third parameter on given cycle. If the hook returns nonzero,
|
6030 |
|
|
the insn is not issued on given processors cycle. Instead of that,
|
6031 |
|
|
the processor cycle is advanced. If the value passed through the last
|
6032 |
|
|
parameter is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
|
6033 |
|
|
start as usually. The first parameter passes file for debugging
|
6034 |
|
|
output. The second one passes the scheduler verbose level of the
|
6035 |
|
|
debugging output. The forth and the fifth parameter values are
|
6036 |
|
|
correspondingly processor cycle on which the previous insn has been
|
6037 |
|
|
issued and the current processor cycle.
|
6038 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6039 |
|
|
|
6040 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (rtx @var{insn1}, rtx @var{insn2}, rtx @var{dep_link}, int @var{dep_cost}, int @var{distance})
|
6041 |
|
|
This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
|
6042 |
|
|
the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
|
6043 |
|
|
are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
|
6044 |
|
|
to this hook are as follows: The second parameter @var{insn2} is dependent
|
6045 |
|
|
upon the first parameter @var{insn1}. The dependence between @var{insn1}
|
6046 |
|
|
and @var{insn2} is represented by the third parameter @var{dep_link}. The
|
6047 |
|
|
fourth parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the dependence, and the fifth
|
6048 |
|
|
parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
|
6049 |
|
|
The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
|
6050 |
|
|
insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
|
6051 |
|
|
and @code{false} otherwise.
|
6052 |
|
|
|
6053 |
|
|
Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
|
6054 |
|
|
where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
|
6055 |
|
|
delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
|
6056 |
|
|
that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
|
6057 |
|
|
important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
|
6058 |
|
|
closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
|
6059 |
|
|
not in cases of "costly dependences", which this hooks allows to define.
|
6060 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6061 |
|
|
|
6062 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST_2 (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{dep_type}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
|
6063 |
|
|
This hook is a modified version of @samp{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST}. Instead
|
6064 |
|
|
of passing dependence as a second parameter, it passes a type of that
|
6065 |
|
|
dependence. This is useful to calculate cost of dependence between insns
|
6066 |
|
|
not having the corresponding link. If @samp{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST_2} is
|
6067 |
|
|
defined it is used instead of @samp{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST}.
|
6068 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6069 |
|
|
|
6070 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
|
6071 |
|
|
This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
|
6072 |
|
|
the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
|
6073 |
|
|
per instruction data structures.
|
6074 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6075 |
|
|
|
6076 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
|
6077 |
|
|
This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
|
6078 |
|
|
speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
|
6079 |
|
|
The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
|
6080 |
|
|
version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
|
6081 |
|
|
pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
|
6082 |
|
|
or -1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
|
6083 |
|
|
speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
|
6084 |
|
|
the generated speculative pattern.
|
6085 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6086 |
|
|
|
6087 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (rtx @var{insn})
|
6088 |
|
|
This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
|
6089 |
|
|
for @var{insn}. It should return nonzero, if the corresponding check
|
6090 |
|
|
instruction should branch to recovery code, or zero otherwise.
|
6091 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6092 |
|
|
|
6093 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
|
6094 |
|
|
This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
|
6095 |
|
|
check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
|
6096 |
|
|
speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
|
6097 |
|
|
@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
|
6098 |
|
|
be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
|
6099 |
|
|
recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
|
6100 |
|
|
a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
|
6101 |
|
|
@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
|
6102 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6103 |
|
|
|
6104 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (rtx @var{insn})
|
6105 |
|
|
This hook is used as a workaround for
|
6106 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
|
6107 |
|
|
called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
|
6108 |
|
|
discard speculative instruction that stand first in the ready list from
|
6109 |
|
|
being scheduled on the current cycle. For non-speculative instructions,
|
6110 |
|
|
the hook should always return nonzero. For example, in the ia64 backend
|
6111 |
|
|
the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
|
6112 |
|
|
is nearly full.
|
6113 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6114 |
|
|
|
6115 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (unsigned int *@var{flags}, spec_info_t @var{spec_info})
|
6116 |
|
|
This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
|
6117 |
|
|
enabled/used. @var{flags} initially may have either the SCHED_RGN or SCHED_EBB
|
6118 |
|
|
bit set. This denotes the scheduler pass for which the data should be
|
6119 |
|
|
provided. The target backend should modify @var{flags} by modifying
|
6120 |
|
|
the bits corresponding to the following features: USE_DEPS_LIST, USE_GLAT,
|
6121 |
|
|
DETACH_LIFE_INFO, and DO_SPECULATION. For the DO_SPECULATION feature
|
6122 |
|
|
an additional structure @var{spec_info} should be filled by the target.
|
6123 |
|
|
The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
|
6124 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6125 |
|
|
|
6126 |
|
|
@node Sections
|
6127 |
|
|
@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
|
6128 |
|
|
@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
|
6129 |
|
|
@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
|
6130 |
|
|
|
6131 |
|
|
An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
|
6132 |
|
|
data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
|
6133 |
|
|
section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
|
6134 |
|
|
section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
|
6135 |
|
|
section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
|
6136 |
|
|
of sections.
|
6137 |
|
|
|
6138 |
|
|
@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
|
6139 |
|
|
@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
|
6140 |
|
|
The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
|
6141 |
|
|
is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
|
6142 |
|
|
as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
|
6143 |
|
|
initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
|
6144 |
|
|
They may however depend on command-line flags.
|
6145 |
|
|
|
6146 |
|
|
@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
|
6147 |
|
|
use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
|
6148 |
|
|
to be string literals.
|
6149 |
|
|
|
6150 |
|
|
Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
|
6151 |
|
|
section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
|
6152 |
|
|
should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
|
6153 |
|
|
@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
|
6154 |
|
|
|
6155 |
|
|
You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
|
6156 |
|
|
@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
|
6157 |
|
|
in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
|
6158 |
|
|
@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
|
6159 |
|
|
create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
|
6160 |
|
|
reuse @code{text_section}.
|
6161 |
|
|
|
6162 |
|
|
All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
|
6163 |
|
|
if the target does not provide them.
|
6164 |
|
|
|
6165 |
|
|
@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6166 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
|
6167 |
|
|
assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
|
6168 |
|
|
Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
|
6169 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6170 |
|
|
|
6171 |
|
|
@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
|
6172 |
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
|
6173 |
|
|
frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
|
6174 |
|
|
a default definition if the target supports named sections.
|
6175 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6176 |
|
|
|
6177 |
|
|
@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
|
6178 |
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
|
6179 |
|
|
executed functions in the program.
|
6180 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6181 |
|
|
|
6182 |
|
|
@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6183 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
|
6184 |
|
|
assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
|
6185 |
|
|
data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
|
6186 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6187 |
|
|
|
6188 |
|
|
@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6189 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
|
6190 |
|
|
containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
|
6191 |
|
|
initialized, writable small data.
|
6192 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6193 |
|
|
|
6194 |
|
|
@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6195 |
|
|
A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
|
6196 |
|
|
assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
|
6197 |
|
|
data.
|
6198 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6199 |
|
|
|
6200 |
|
|
@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6201 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
|
6202 |
|
|
containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
|
6203 |
|
|
uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
|
6204 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
|
6205 |
|
|
uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
|
6206 |
|
|
@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
|
6207 |
|
|
used.
|
6208 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6209 |
|
|
|
6210 |
|
|
@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6211 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
|
6212 |
|
|
containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
|
6213 |
|
|
uninitialized, writable small data.
|
6214 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6215 |
|
|
|
6216 |
|
|
@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6217 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
|
6218 |
|
|
containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
|
6219 |
|
|
initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
|
6220 |
|
|
not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
|
6221 |
|
|
variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
|
6222 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6223 |
|
|
|
6224 |
|
|
@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6225 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
|
6226 |
|
|
containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
|
6227 |
|
|
finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
|
6228 |
|
|
not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
|
6229 |
|
|
variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
|
6230 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6231 |
|
|
|
6232 |
|
|
@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6233 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
|
6234 |
|
|
containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
|
6235 |
|
|
part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
|
6236 |
|
|
defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
|
6237 |
|
|
both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
|
6238 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6239 |
|
|
|
6240 |
|
|
@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
6241 |
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
|
6242 |
|
|
containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
|
6243 |
|
|
part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
|
6244 |
|
|
defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
|
6245 |
|
|
both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
|
6246 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6247 |
|
|
|
6248 |
|
|
@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
|
6249 |
|
|
If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
|
6250 |
|
|
via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
|
6251 |
|
|
the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
|
6252 |
|
|
@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
|
6253 |
|
|
to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
|
6254 |
|
|
sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
|
6255 |
|
|
ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
|
6256 |
|
|
registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
|
6257 |
|
|
constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
|
6258 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6259 |
|
|
|
6260 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
|
6261 |
|
|
If defined, a string which names the section into which small
|
6262 |
|
|
variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
|
6263 |
|
|
when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
|
6264 |
|
|
you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
|
6265 |
|
|
they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
|
6266 |
|
|
expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
|
6267 |
|
|
MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
|
6268 |
|
|
require small data support from your application, but use this macro
|
6269 |
|
|
to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
|
6270 |
|
|
access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
|
6271 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6272 |
|
|
|
6273 |
|
|
@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
|
6274 |
|
|
If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
|
6275 |
|
|
arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
|
6276 |
|
|
@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
|
6277 |
|
|
and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
|
6278 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6279 |
|
|
|
6280 |
|
|
@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
|
6281 |
|
|
Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
|
6282 |
|
|
tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
|
6283 |
|
|
section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
|
6284 |
|
|
readonly data section is used.
|
6285 |
|
|
|
6286 |
|
|
This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
|
6287 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6288 |
|
|
|
6289 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
|
6290 |
|
|
Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
|
6291 |
|
|
@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
|
6292 |
|
|
of its own that you need to create.
|
6293 |
|
|
|
6294 |
|
|
GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
|
6295 |
|
|
any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
|
6296 |
|
|
described below.
|
6297 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6298 |
|
|
|
6299 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
|
6300 |
|
|
Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
|
6301 |
|
|
selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
|
6302 |
|
|
should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
|
6303 |
|
|
local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
|
6304 |
|
|
|
6305 |
|
|
The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
|
6306 |
|
|
is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
|
6307 |
|
|
when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
|
6308 |
|
|
in read-only sections even in executables.
|
6309 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6310 |
|
|
|
6311 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
|
6312 |
|
|
Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
|
6313 |
|
|
assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
|
6314 |
|
|
some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
|
6315 |
|
|
requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
|
6316 |
|
|
local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
|
6317 |
|
|
@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
|
6318 |
|
|
|
6319 |
|
|
The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
|
6320 |
|
|
variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
|
6321 |
|
|
|
6322 |
|
|
See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
|
6323 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6324 |
|
|
|
6325 |
|
|
@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
|
6326 |
|
|
Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
|
6327 |
|
|
for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
|
6328 |
|
|
|
6329 |
|
|
In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
|
6330 |
|
|
function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
|
6331 |
|
|
it is unlikely to be called.
|
6332 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6333 |
|
|
|
6334 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
|
6335 |
|
|
Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
|
6336 |
|
|
and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
|
6337 |
|
|
As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
|
6338 |
|
|
the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
|
6339 |
|
|
|
6340 |
|
|
The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
|
6341 |
|
|
ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
|
6342 |
|
|
example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
|
6343 |
|
|
Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
|
6344 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6345 |
|
|
|
6346 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
|
6347 |
|
|
Return the readonly data section associated with
|
6348 |
|
|
@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
|
6349 |
|
|
The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
|
6350 |
|
|
the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
|
6351 |
|
|
if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
|
6352 |
|
|
otherwise.
|
6353 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6354 |
|
|
|
6355 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
|
6356 |
|
|
Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
|
6357 |
|
|
should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
|
6358 |
|
|
constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
|
6359 |
|
|
case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
|
6360 |
|
|
in bits.
|
6361 |
|
|
|
6362 |
|
|
The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
|
6363 |
|
|
constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
|
6364 |
|
|
else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
|
6365 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6366 |
|
|
|
6367 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
|
6368 |
|
|
Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
|
6369 |
|
|
treated differently depending on something about the variable or
|
6370 |
|
|
function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
|
6371 |
|
|
|
6372 |
|
|
The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
|
6373 |
|
|
@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
|
6374 |
|
|
an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
|
6375 |
|
|
rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
|
6376 |
|
|
in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
|
6377 |
|
|
|
6378 |
|
|
In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
|
6379 |
|
|
a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
|
6380 |
|
|
will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
|
6381 |
|
|
register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
|
6382 |
|
|
rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
|
6383 |
|
|
leave it alone.)
|
6384 |
|
|
|
6385 |
|
|
The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
|
6386 |
|
|
that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
|
6387 |
|
|
be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
|
6388 |
|
|
declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
|
6389 |
|
|
declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
|
6390 |
|
|
@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
|
6391 |
|
|
|
6392 |
|
|
@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
|
6393 |
|
|
The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
|
6394 |
|
|
@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
|
6395 |
|
|
Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
|
6396 |
|
|
encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
|
6397 |
|
|
discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
|
6398 |
|
|
|
6399 |
|
|
The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
|
6400 |
|
|
in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
|
6401 |
|
|
@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
|
6402 |
|
|
before overriding it.
|
6403 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6404 |
|
|
|
6405 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *name)
|
6406 |
|
|
Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
|
6407 |
|
|
the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
|
6408 |
|
|
may have added.
|
6409 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6410 |
|
|
|
6411 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (tree @var{exp})
|
6412 |
|
|
Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
|
6413 |
|
|
The default version of this hook always returns false.
|
6414 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6415 |
|
|
|
6416 |
|
|
@deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
|
6417 |
|
|
Contains the value true if the target places read-only
|
6418 |
|
|
``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
|
6419 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
6420 |
|
|
|
6421 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (tree @var{exp})
|
6422 |
|
|
Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
|
6423 |
|
|
rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
|
6424 |
|
|
or executable image).
|
6425 |
|
|
|
6426 |
|
|
The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
|
6427 |
|
|
for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
|
6428 |
|
|
currently supported object file formats.
|
6429 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6430 |
|
|
|
6431 |
|
|
@deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
|
6432 |
|
|
Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
|
6433 |
|
|
The default value is false.
|
6434 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
6435 |
|
|
|
6436 |
|
|
|
6437 |
|
|
@node PIC
|
6438 |
|
|
@section Position Independent Code
|
6439 |
|
|
@cindex position independent code
|
6440 |
|
|
@cindex PIC
|
6441 |
|
|
|
6442 |
|
|
This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
|
6443 |
|
|
independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
|
6444 |
|
|
generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
|
6445 |
|
|
@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
|
6446 |
|
|
well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You must modify the definition of
|
6447 |
|
|
@samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
|
6448 |
|
|
contains a symbolic address. You may also need to alter the handling of
|
6449 |
|
|
switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
|
6450 |
|
|
@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
|
6451 |
|
|
@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
|
6452 |
|
|
|
6453 |
|
|
@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
|
6454 |
|
|
The register number of the register used to address a table of static
|
6455 |
|
|
data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
|
6456 |
|
|
processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
|
6457 |
|
|
is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
|
6458 |
|
|
pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
|
6459 |
|
|
is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
|
6460 |
|
|
necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
|
6461 |
|
|
when @code{flag_pic} is true).
|
6462 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6463 |
|
|
|
6464 |
|
|
@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
|
6465 |
|
|
Define this macro if the register defined by
|
6466 |
|
|
@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. Do not define
|
6467 |
|
|
this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
|
6468 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6469 |
|
|
|
6470 |
|
|
@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
|
6471 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
|
6472 |
|
|
operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
|
6473 |
|
|
You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
|
6474 |
|
|
check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
|
6475 |
|
|
check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
|
6476 |
|
|
(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
|
6477 |
|
|
position independent code.
|
6478 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6479 |
|
|
|
6480 |
|
|
@node Assembler Format
|
6481 |
|
|
@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
|
6482 |
|
|
|
6483 |
|
|
This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
|
6484 |
|
|
to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
|
6485 |
|
|
instructions do.
|
6486 |
|
|
|
6487 |
|
|
@menu
|
6488 |
|
|
* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
|
6489 |
|
|
* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
|
6490 |
|
|
* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
|
6491 |
|
|
* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
|
6492 |
|
|
* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
|
6493 |
|
|
and termination routines.
|
6494 |
|
|
* Macros for Initialization::
|
6495 |
|
|
Specific macros that control the handling of
|
6496 |
|
|
initialization and termination routines.
|
6497 |
|
|
* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
|
6498 |
|
|
* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
|
6499 |
|
|
* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
|
6500 |
|
|
* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
|
6501 |
|
|
@end menu
|
6502 |
|
|
|
6503 |
|
|
@node File Framework
|
6504 |
|
|
@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
|
6505 |
|
|
@cindex assembler format
|
6506 |
|
|
@cindex output of assembler code
|
6507 |
|
|
|
6508 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
6509 |
|
|
This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
|
6510 |
|
|
|
6511 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START ()
|
6512 |
|
|
@findex default_file_start
|
6513 |
|
|
Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
|
6514 |
|
|
find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
|
6515 |
|
|
by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
|
6516 |
|
|
quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
|
6517 |
|
|
@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
|
6518 |
|
|
lets other target files rely on these variables.
|
6519 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6520 |
|
|
|
6521 |
|
|
@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
|
6522 |
|
|
If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
|
6523 |
|
|
printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
|
6524 |
|
|
@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
|
6525 |
|
|
to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
|
6526 |
|
|
definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
|
6527 |
|
|
assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
|
6528 |
|
|
whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
|
6529 |
|
|
|
6530 |
|
|
The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
|
6531 |
|
|
verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
|
6532 |
|
|
comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
|
6533 |
|
|
@end deftypevr
|
6534 |
|
|
|
6535 |
|
|
@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
|
6536 |
|
|
If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
|
6537 |
|
|
for the primary source file, immediately after printing
|
6538 |
|
|
@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
|
6539 |
|
|
this to be done. The default is false.
|
6540 |
|
|
@end deftypevr
|
6541 |
|
|
|
6542 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END ()
|
6543 |
|
|
Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
|
6544 |
|
|
to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
|
6545 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6546 |
|
|
|
6547 |
|
|
@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
|
6548 |
|
|
Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
|
6549 |
|
|
special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
|
6550 |
|
|
the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
|
6551 |
|
|
should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
|
6552 |
|
|
need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
|
6553 |
|
|
this function.
|
6554 |
|
|
@end deftypefun
|
6555 |
|
|
|
6556 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
|
6557 |
|
|
A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
|
6558 |
|
|
assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
|
6559 |
|
|
the end of the line.
|
6560 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6561 |
|
|
|
6562 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_APP_ON
|
6563 |
|
|
A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
|
6564 |
|
|
statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
|
6565 |
|
|
@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
|
6566 |
|
|
assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
|
6567 |
|
|
that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
|
6568 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6569 |
|
|
|
6570 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
|
6571 |
|
|
A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
|
6572 |
|
|
statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
|
6573 |
|
|
@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
|
6574 |
|
|
time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
|
6575 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6576 |
|
|
|
6577 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
6578 |
|
|
A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
|
6579 |
|
|
which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
|
6580 |
|
|
the stdio stream @var{stream}.
|
6581 |
|
|
|
6582 |
|
|
This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
|
6583 |
|
|
for the file format in use is appropriate.
|
6584 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6585 |
|
|
|
6586 |
|
|
@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
|
6587 |
|
|
A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
|
6588 |
|
|
@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
|
6589 |
|
|
in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
|
6590 |
|
|
the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
|
6591 |
|
|
of the filename using this macro.
|
6592 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6593 |
|
|
|
6594 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
|
6595 |
|
|
A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
|
6596 |
|
|
@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
|
6597 |
|
|
macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
|
6598 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6599 |
|
|
|
6600 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int @var{align})
|
6601 |
|
|
Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
|
6602 |
|
|
should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
|
6603 |
|
|
of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{align}
|
6604 |
|
|
is nonzero, it contains an alignment in bytes to be used for the section,
|
6605 |
|
|
otherwise some target default should be used. Only targets that must
|
6606 |
|
|
specify an alignment within the section directive need pay attention to
|
6607 |
|
|
@var{align} -- we will still use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}.
|
6608 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6609 |
|
|
|
6610 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
|
6611 |
|
|
This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
|
6612 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6613 |
|
|
|
6614 |
|
|
@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
|
6615 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
|
6616 |
|
|
This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
|
6617 |
|
|
section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
|
6618 |
|
|
This is true on most ELF targets.
|
6619 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6620 |
|
|
|
6621 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
|
6622 |
|
|
Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
|
6623 |
|
|
based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
|
6624 |
|
|
declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
|
6625 |
|
|
null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
|
6626 |
|
|
|
6627 |
|
|
The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
|
6628 |
|
|
read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
|
6629 |
|
|
need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
|
6630 |
|
|
set via @code{__attribute__}.
|
6631 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6632 |
|
|
|
6633 |
|
|
@need 2000
|
6634 |
|
|
@node Data Output
|
6635 |
|
|
@subsection Output of Data
|
6636 |
|
|
|
6637 |
|
|
|
6638 |
|
|
@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
|
6639 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
|
6640 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
|
6641 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
|
6642 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
|
6643 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
|
6644 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
|
6645 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
|
6646 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
|
6647 |
|
|
These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
|
6648 |
|
|
of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
|
6649 |
|
|
byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
|
6650 |
|
|
aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
|
6651 |
|
|
@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
|
6652 |
|
|
|
6653 |
|
|
The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
|
6654 |
|
|
followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
|
6655 |
|
|
the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
|
6656 |
|
|
@end deftypevr
|
6657 |
|
|
|
6658 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
|
6659 |
|
|
The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
|
6660 |
|
|
integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
|
6661 |
|
|
in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
|
6662 |
|
|
function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
|
6663 |
|
|
object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
|
6664 |
|
|
split the object into smaller parts.
|
6665 |
|
|
|
6666 |
|
|
The default implementation of this hook will use the
|
6667 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
|
6668 |
|
|
when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
|
6669 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
6670 |
|
|
|
6671 |
|
|
@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
|
6672 |
|
|
A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
|
6673 |
|
|
@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
|
6674 |
|
|
@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
|
6675 |
|
|
allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
|
6676 |
|
|
|
6677 |
|
|
If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
|
6678 |
|
|
@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
|
6679 |
|
|
prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
|
6680 |
|
|
@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
|
6681 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6682 |
|
|
|
6683 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
|
6684 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
6685 |
|
|
instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
|
6686 |
|
|
bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
|
6687 |
|
|
@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
|
6688 |
|
|
|
6689 |
|
|
If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
|
6690 |
|
|
Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
|
6691 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
|
6692 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6693 |
|
|
|
6694 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
|
6695 |
|
|
A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
|
6696 |
|
|
@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
|
6697 |
|
|
is defined, and is otherwise unused.
|
6698 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6699 |
|
|
|
6700 |
|
|
@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
|
6701 |
|
|
You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
|
6702 |
|
|
expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
|
6703 |
|
|
pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
|
6704 |
|
|
GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
|
6705 |
|
|
not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
|
6706 |
|
|
pool before the function.
|
6707 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6708 |
|
|
|
6709 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
|
6710 |
|
|
A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
|
6711 |
|
|
constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
|
6712 |
|
|
the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
|
6713 |
|
|
be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
|
6714 |
|
|
is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
|
6715 |
|
|
immediately after this call.
|
6716 |
|
|
|
6717 |
|
|
If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
|
6718 |
|
|
not be defined.
|
6719 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6720 |
|
|
|
6721 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
|
6722 |
|
|
A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
|
6723 |
|
|
constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
|
6724 |
|
|
anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
|
6725 |
|
|
|
6726 |
|
|
The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
|
6727 |
|
|
assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
|
6728 |
|
|
output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
|
6729 |
|
|
@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
|
6730 |
|
|
@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
|
6731 |
|
|
alignment.
|
6732 |
|
|
|
6733 |
|
|
The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
|
6734 |
|
|
the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
|
6735 |
|
|
responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
|
6736 |
|
|
Here is how to do this:
|
6737 |
|
|
|
6738 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
6739 |
|
|
@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
|
6740 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
6741 |
|
|
|
6742 |
|
|
When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
|
6743 |
|
|
@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
|
6744 |
|
|
entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
|
6745 |
|
|
|
6746 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
|
6747 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6748 |
|
|
|
6749 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
|
6750 |
|
|
A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
|
6751 |
|
|
pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
|
6752 |
|
|
function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
|
6753 |
|
|
obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
|
6754 |
|
|
constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
|
6755 |
|
|
|
6756 |
|
|
If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
|
6757 |
|
|
define this macro.
|
6758 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6759 |
|
|
|
6760 |
|
|
@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
|
6761 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
|
6762 |
|
|
used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
|
6763 |
|
|
|
6764 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
|
6765 |
|
|
the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
|
6766 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6767 |
|
|
|
6768 |
|
|
@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
|
6769 |
|
|
@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
|
6770 |
|
|
These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
|
6771 |
|
|
assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
|
6772 |
|
|
default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
|
6773 |
|
|
@end deftypevr
|
6774 |
|
|
|
6775 |
|
|
These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
|
6776 |
|
|
of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
|
6777 |
|
|
|
6778 |
|
|
@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
6779 |
|
|
@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
6780 |
|
|
@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
6781 |
|
|
@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
6782 |
|
|
@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
6783 |
|
|
@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
6784 |
|
|
These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
|
6785 |
|
|
target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
|
6786 |
|
|
the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
|
6787 |
|
|
@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
|
6788 |
|
|
simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
|
6789 |
|
|
@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
|
6790 |
|
|
by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
|
6791 |
|
|
it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
|
6792 |
|
|
32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
|
6793 |
|
|
on the host machine.
|
6794 |
|
|
|
6795 |
|
|
The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
|
6796 |
|
|
using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
|
6797 |
|
|
machine's memory.
|
6798 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6799 |
|
|
|
6800 |
|
|
@node Uninitialized Data
|
6801 |
|
|
@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
|
6802 |
|
|
|
6803 |
|
|
Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
|
6804 |
|
|
outputting a single uninitialized variable.
|
6805 |
|
|
|
6806 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
6807 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
6808 |
|
|
@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
|
6809 |
|
|
@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
|
6810 |
|
|
is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
|
6811 |
|
|
|
6812 |
|
|
Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
|
6813 |
|
|
output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
|
6814 |
|
|
assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
|
6815 |
|
|
|
6816 |
|
|
This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
|
6817 |
|
|
common global variables are output.
|
6818 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6819 |
|
|
|
6820 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
6821 |
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
|
6822 |
|
|
separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
|
6823 |
|
|
place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
|
6824 |
|
|
handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
|
6825 |
|
|
as the number of bits.
|
6826 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6827 |
|
|
|
6828 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
6829 |
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
|
6830 |
|
|
variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
|
6831 |
|
|
is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
|
6832 |
|
|
in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
|
6833 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
|
6834 |
|
|
the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
|
6835 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6836 |
|
|
|
6837 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
6838 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
6839 |
|
|
@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
|
6840 |
|
|
@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
|
6841 |
|
|
is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
|
6842 |
|
|
|
6843 |
|
|
Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
|
6844 |
|
|
defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
|
6845 |
|
|
@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
|
6846 |
|
|
before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
|
6847 |
|
|
the name, and a newline.
|
6848 |
|
|
|
6849 |
|
|
There are two ways of handling global BSS. One is to define either
|
6850 |
|
|
this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
|
6851 |
|
|
The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
|
6852 |
|
|
switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
|
6853 |
|
|
You do not need to do both.
|
6854 |
|
|
|
6855 |
|
|
Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
|
6856 |
|
|
non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
|
6857 |
|
|
efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
|
6858 |
|
|
not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
|
6859 |
|
|
common in order to save space in the object file.
|
6860 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6861 |
|
|
|
6862 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
6863 |
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
|
6864 |
|
|
separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
|
6865 |
|
|
place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
|
6866 |
|
|
handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
|
6867 |
|
|
as the number of bits.
|
6868 |
|
|
|
6869 |
|
|
Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
|
6870 |
|
|
@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
|
6871 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6872 |
|
|
|
6873 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
6874 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
6875 |
|
|
@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
|
6876 |
|
|
@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
|
6877 |
|
|
is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
|
6878 |
|
|
|
6879 |
|
|
Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
|
6880 |
|
|
output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
|
6881 |
|
|
assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
|
6882 |
|
|
|
6883 |
|
|
This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
|
6884 |
|
|
static variables are output.
|
6885 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6886 |
|
|
|
6887 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
6888 |
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
|
6889 |
|
|
separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
|
6890 |
|
|
place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
|
6891 |
|
|
handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
|
6892 |
|
|
as the number of bits.
|
6893 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6894 |
|
|
|
6895 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
6896 |
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
|
6897 |
|
|
variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
|
6898 |
|
|
is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
|
6899 |
|
|
in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
|
6900 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
|
6901 |
|
|
the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
|
6902 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6903 |
|
|
|
6904 |
|
|
@node Label Output
|
6905 |
|
|
@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
|
6906 |
|
|
|
6907 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
6908 |
|
|
This is about outputting labels.
|
6909 |
|
|
|
6910 |
|
|
@findex assemble_name
|
6911 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
6912 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
6913 |
|
|
@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
|
6914 |
|
|
Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
|
6915 |
|
|
output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
|
6916 |
|
|
assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
|
6917 |
|
|
definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
|
6918 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6919 |
|
|
|
6920 |
|
|
@findex assemble_name_raw
|
6921 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
6922 |
|
|
Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
|
6923 |
|
|
to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
|
6924 |
|
|
@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
|
6925 |
|
|
that it is more efficient.
|
6926 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6927 |
|
|
|
6928 |
|
|
@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
|
6929 |
|
|
A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
|
6930 |
|
|
size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
|
6931 |
|
|
default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
|
6932 |
|
|
systems, the default is not to define this macro.
|
6933 |
|
|
|
6934 |
|
|
Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
|
6935 |
|
|
of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
|
6936 |
|
|
for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
|
6937 |
|
|
macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
|
6938 |
|
|
define this macro.
|
6939 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6940 |
|
|
|
6941 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
|
6942 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
6943 |
|
|
@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
|
6944 |
|
|
symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
|
6945 |
|
|
If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
|
6946 |
|
|
provided.
|
6947 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6948 |
|
|
|
6949 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
6950 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
6951 |
|
|
@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
|
6952 |
|
|
the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
|
6953 |
|
|
address.
|
6954 |
|
|
|
6955 |
|
|
If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
|
6956 |
|
|
provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
|
6957 |
|
|
@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
|
6958 |
|
|
the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
|
6959 |
|
|
not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
|
6960 |
|
|
to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
|
6961 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6962 |
|
|
|
6963 |
|
|
@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
|
6964 |
|
|
A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
|
6965 |
|
|
type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
|
6966 |
|
|
default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
|
6967 |
|
|
systems, the default is not to define this macro.
|
6968 |
|
|
|
6969 |
|
|
Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
|
6970 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
|
6971 |
|
|
custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
|
6972 |
|
|
types at all, do not define this macro.
|
6973 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6974 |
|
|
|
6975 |
|
|
@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
|
6976 |
|
|
A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
|
6977 |
|
|
the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
|
6978 |
|
|
default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
|
6979 |
|
|
the default is not to define this macro.
|
6980 |
|
|
|
6981 |
|
|
Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
|
6982 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
|
6983 |
|
|
custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
|
6984 |
|
|
types at all, do not define this macro.
|
6985 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6986 |
|
|
|
6987 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
|
6988 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
6989 |
|
|
@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
|
6990 |
|
|
symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
|
6991 |
|
|
that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
|
6992 |
|
|
you should not count on this.
|
6993 |
|
|
|
6994 |
|
|
If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
|
6995 |
|
|
definition of this macro is provided.
|
6996 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
6997 |
|
|
|
6998 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
|
6999 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7000 |
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
|
7001 |
|
|
function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
|
7002 |
|
|
outputting the label definition (perhaps using
|
7003 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
|
7004 |
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
|
7005 |
|
|
|
7006 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
|
7007 |
|
|
usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
|
7008 |
|
|
|
7009 |
|
|
You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
|
7010 |
|
|
of this macro.
|
7011 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7012 |
|
|
|
7013 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
|
7014 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7015 |
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
|
7016 |
|
|
which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
|
7017 |
|
|
function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
|
7018 |
|
|
representing the function.
|
7019 |
|
|
|
7020 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
|
7021 |
|
|
|
7022 |
|
|
You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
|
7023 |
|
|
of this macro.
|
7024 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7025 |
|
|
|
7026 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
|
7027 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7028 |
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
|
7029 |
|
|
initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
|
7030 |
|
|
label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
|
7031 |
|
|
@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
|
7032 |
|
|
|
7033 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
|
7034 |
|
|
usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
|
7035 |
|
|
|
7036 |
|
|
You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
|
7037 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
|
7038 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7039 |
|
|
|
7040 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{exp}, @var{size})
|
7041 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7042 |
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
|
7043 |
|
|
constant which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
|
7044 |
|
|
outputting the label definition (perhaps using
|
7045 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument @var{exp} is the
|
7046 |
|
|
value of the constant, and @var{size} is the size of the constant
|
7047 |
|
|
in bytes. @var{name} will be an internal label.
|
7048 |
|
|
|
7049 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then the @var{name} is defined in the
|
7050 |
|
|
usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
|
7051 |
|
|
|
7052 |
|
|
You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
|
7053 |
|
|
of this macro.
|
7054 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7055 |
|
|
|
7056 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
|
7057 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7058 |
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
|
7059 |
|
|
for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
|
7060 |
|
|
|
7061 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
|
7062 |
|
|
nothing.
|
7063 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7064 |
|
|
|
7065 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
|
7066 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
|
7067 |
|
|
once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
|
7068 |
|
|
chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
|
7069 |
|
|
initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
|
7070 |
|
|
something about the size of the object.
|
7071 |
|
|
|
7072 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
|
7073 |
|
|
nothing.
|
7074 |
|
|
|
7075 |
|
|
You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
|
7076 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
|
7077 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7078 |
|
|
|
7079 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
|
7080 |
|
|
This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
|
7081 |
|
|
@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
|
7082 |
|
|
that is, available for reference from other files.
|
7083 |
|
|
|
7084 |
|
|
The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
|
7085 |
|
|
@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
|
7086 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7087 |
|
|
|
7088 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
7089 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7090 |
|
|
@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
|
7091 |
|
|
that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
|
7092 |
|
|
no other definition is available. Use the expression
|
7093 |
|
|
@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
|
7094 |
|
|
itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
|
7095 |
|
|
for making that name weak, and a newline.
|
7096 |
|
|
|
7097 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
|
7098 |
|
|
support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
|
7099 |
|
|
macro.
|
7100 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7101 |
|
|
|
7102 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
|
7103 |
|
|
Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
|
7104 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
|
7105 |
|
|
or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
|
7106 |
|
|
should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
|
7107 |
|
|
defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
|
7108 |
|
|
@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
|
7109 |
|
|
to make @var{name} weak.
|
7110 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7111 |
|
|
|
7112 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
|
7113 |
|
|
Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
|
7114 |
|
|
symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
|
7115 |
|
|
declaration of @code{name}.
|
7116 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7117 |
|
|
|
7118 |
|
|
@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
|
7119 |
|
|
A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
|
7120 |
|
|
|
7121 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
|
7122 |
|
|
definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
|
7123 |
|
|
is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
|
7124 |
|
|
@samp{0}. Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
|
7125 |
|
|
with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
|
7126 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7127 |
|
|
|
7128 |
|
|
@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
|
7129 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
|
7130 |
|
|
public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
|
7131 |
|
|
be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
|
7132 |
|
|
format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
|
7133 |
|
|
section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
|
7134 |
|
|
requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
|
7135 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7136 |
|
|
|
7137 |
|
|
@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
|
7138 |
|
|
A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
|
7139 |
|
|
semantics.
|
7140 |
|
|
|
7141 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
|
7142 |
|
|
definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
|
7143 |
|
|
definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
|
7144 |
|
|
you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
|
7145 |
|
|
setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
|
7146 |
|
|
be emitted as one-only.
|
7147 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7148 |
|
|
|
7149 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{visibility})
|
7150 |
|
|
This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
|
7151 |
|
|
commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
|
7152 |
|
|
hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
|
7153 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7154 |
|
|
|
7155 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
|
7156 |
|
|
A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
|
7157 |
|
|
that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
|
7158 |
|
|
The default is @code{0}.
|
7159 |
|
|
|
7160 |
|
|
Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
|
7161 |
|
|
if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
|
7162 |
|
|
will have undefined references from other translation units, that
|
7163 |
|
|
symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
|
7164 |
|
|
thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
|
7165 |
|
|
(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
|
7166 |
|
|
with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
|
7167 |
|
|
|
7168 |
|
|
The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
|
7169 |
|
|
targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
|
7170 |
|
|
restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
|
7171 |
|
|
table of contents.
|
7172 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7173 |
|
|
|
7174 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
|
7175 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7176 |
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
|
7177 |
|
|
symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
|
7178 |
|
|
not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
|
7179 |
|
|
declaration.
|
7180 |
|
|
|
7181 |
|
|
This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
|
7182 |
|
|
The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
|
7183 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7184 |
|
|
|
7185 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
|
7186 |
|
|
This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
|
7187 |
|
|
pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
|
7188 |
|
|
library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
|
7189 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7190 |
|
|
|
7191 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (tree @var{decl})
|
7192 |
|
|
This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
|
7193 |
|
|
directive to annotate used symbol. Darwin target use .no_dead_code_strip
|
7194 |
|
|
directive.
|
7195 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7196 |
|
|
|
7197 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
7198 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7199 |
|
|
@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
|
7200 |
|
|
@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
|
7201 |
|
|
is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
|
7202 |
|
|
systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
|
7203 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7204 |
|
|
|
7205 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
|
7206 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
|
7207 |
|
|
@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
|
7208 |
|
|
will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
|
7209 |
|
|
to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
|
7210 |
|
|
encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
|
7211 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7212 |
|
|
|
7213 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
|
7214 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
|
7215 |
|
|
result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
|
7216 |
|
|
@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
|
7217 |
|
|
This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
|
7218 |
|
|
specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
|
7219 |
|
|
when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
|
7220 |
|
|
being taken.
|
7221 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7222 |
|
|
|
7223 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
|
7224 |
|
|
A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
|
7225 |
|
|
name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
|
7226 |
|
|
|
7227 |
|
|
It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
|
7228 |
|
|
used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
|
7229 |
|
|
will have name conflicts with internal labels.
|
7230 |
|
|
|
7231 |
|
|
It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
|
7232 |
|
|
object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
|
7233 |
|
|
should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
|
7234 |
|
|
beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
|
7235 |
|
|
convention your system uses, and follow it.
|
7236 |
|
|
|
7237 |
|
|
The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
|
7238 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7239 |
|
|
|
7240 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
|
7241 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
|
7242 |
|
|
label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
|
7243 |
|
|
@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
|
7244 |
|
|
may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
|
7245 |
|
|
systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
|
7246 |
|
|
bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
|
7247 |
|
|
bundles.
|
7248 |
|
|
|
7249 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
|
7250 |
|
|
used.
|
7251 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7252 |
|
|
|
7253 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
|
7254 |
|
|
A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
|
7255 |
|
|
is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
|
7256 |
|
|
|
7257 |
|
|
This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
|
7258 |
|
|
produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
|
7259 |
|
|
with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
|
7260 |
|
|
|
7261 |
|
|
If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
|
7262 |
|
|
output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
|
7263 |
|
|
@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
|
7264 |
|
|
string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
|
7265 |
|
|
to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
|
7266 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
|
7267 |
|
|
you should know what it does on your machine.)
|
7268 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7269 |
|
|
|
7270 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
|
7271 |
|
|
A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
|
7272 |
|
|
@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
|
7273 |
|
|
@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
|
7274 |
|
|
added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
|
7275 |
|
|
|
7276 |
|
|
The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
|
7277 |
|
|
produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
|
7278 |
|
|
@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
|
7279 |
|
|
assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
|
7280 |
|
|
macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
|
7281 |
|
|
internal static variables in different scopes.
|
7282 |
|
|
|
7283 |
|
|
Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
|
7284 |
|
|
conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
|
7285 |
|
|
or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
|
7286 |
|
|
between the name and the number will suffice.
|
7287 |
|
|
|
7288 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
|
7289 |
|
|
which is correct for most systems.
|
7290 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7291 |
|
|
|
7292 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
|
7293 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
|
7294 |
|
|
which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
|
7295 |
|
|
|
7296 |
|
|
@findex SET_ASM_OP
|
7297 |
|
|
If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
|
7298 |
|
|
correct for most systems.
|
7299 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7300 |
|
|
|
7301 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
|
7302 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
|
7303 |
|
|
which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
|
7304 |
|
|
to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
|
7305 |
|
|
be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
|
7306 |
|
|
the tree nodes are available.
|
7307 |
|
|
|
7308 |
|
|
@findex SET_ASM_OP
|
7309 |
|
|
If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
|
7310 |
|
|
correct for most systems.
|
7311 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7312 |
|
|
|
7313 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
|
7314 |
|
|
A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
|
7315 |
|
|
(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
|
7316 |
|
|
of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
|
7317 |
|
|
current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
|
7318 |
|
|
This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
|
7319 |
|
|
@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
|
7320 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7321 |
|
|
|
7322 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
|
7323 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
|
7324 |
|
|
which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
|
7325 |
|
|
@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
|
7326 |
|
|
an undefined weak symbol.
|
7327 |
|
|
|
7328 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
|
7329 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
|
7330 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7331 |
|
|
|
7332 |
|
|
@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
|
7333 |
|
|
Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
|
7334 |
|
|
Objective-C methods.
|
7335 |
|
|
|
7336 |
|
|
The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
|
7337 |
|
|
class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
|
7338 |
|
|
the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
|
7339 |
|
|
@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
|
7340 |
|
|
|
7341 |
|
|
These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
|
7342 |
|
|
the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
|
7343 |
|
|
systems define other ways of computing names.
|
7344 |
|
|
|
7345 |
|
|
@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
|
7346 |
|
|
buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
|
7347 |
|
|
@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
|
7348 |
|
|
50 characters extra.
|
7349 |
|
|
|
7350 |
|
|
The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
|
7351 |
|
|
method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
|
7352 |
|
|
@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
|
7353 |
|
|
in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
|
7354 |
|
|
|
7355 |
|
|
On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
|
7356 |
|
|
macro to provide more human-readable names.
|
7357 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7358 |
|
|
|
7359 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
7360 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7361 |
|
|
@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
|
7362 |
|
|
Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
|
7363 |
|
|
linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
|
7364 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7365 |
|
|
|
7366 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
7367 |
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
7368 |
|
|
@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
|
7369 |
|
|
unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
|
7370 |
|
|
whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
|
7371 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7372 |
|
|
|
7373 |
|
|
@node Initialization
|
7374 |
|
|
@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
|
7375 |
|
|
@cindex initialization routines
|
7376 |
|
|
@cindex termination routines
|
7377 |
|
|
@cindex constructors, output of
|
7378 |
|
|
@cindex destructors, output of
|
7379 |
|
|
|
7380 |
|
|
The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
|
7381 |
|
|
(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
|
7382 |
|
|
data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
|
7383 |
|
|
to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
|
7384 |
|
|
@code{main} is called.
|
7385 |
|
|
|
7386 |
|
|
Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
|
7387 |
|
|
@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
|
7388 |
|
|
terminates.
|
7389 |
|
|
|
7390 |
|
|
To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
|
7391 |
|
|
must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
|
7392 |
|
|
be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
|
7393 |
|
|
system, you need to specify how to do this.
|
7394 |
|
|
|
7395 |
|
|
There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
|
7396 |
|
|
initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
|
7397 |
|
|
Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
|
7398 |
|
|
|
7399 |
|
|
@findex __CTOR_LIST__
|
7400 |
|
|
@findex __DTOR_LIST__
|
7401 |
|
|
The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
|
7402 |
|
|
initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
|
7403 |
|
|
termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
|
7404 |
|
|
|
7405 |
|
|
Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
|
7406 |
|
|
0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
|
7407 |
|
|
the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
|
7408 |
|
|
pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
|
7409 |
|
|
pointer containing zero.
|
7410 |
|
|
|
7411 |
|
|
Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
|
7412 |
|
|
@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
|
7413 |
|
|
time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
|
7414 |
|
|
list; destructors in forward order.
|
7415 |
|
|
|
7416 |
|
|
The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
|
7417 |
|
|
formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
|
7418 |
|
|
aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
|
7419 |
|
|
Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
|
7420 |
|
|
object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
|
7421 |
|
|
the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
|
7422 |
|
|
accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
|
7423 |
|
|
Termination functions are handled similarly.
|
7424 |
|
|
|
7425 |
|
|
This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
|
7426 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
|
7427 |
|
|
support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
|
7428 |
|
|
constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
|
7429 |
|
|
and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
|
7430 |
|
|
|
7431 |
|
|
When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
|
7432 |
|
|
upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
|
7433 |
|
|
support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
|
7434 |
|
|
parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
|
7435 |
|
|
program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
|
7436 |
|
|
|
7437 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
7438 |
|
|
ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
|
7439 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
7440 |
|
|
|
7441 |
|
|
The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
|
7442 |
|
|
section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
|
7443 |
|
|
for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
|
7444 |
|
|
files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
|
7445 |
|
|
are provided by GCC for a few targets.
|
7446 |
|
|
|
7447 |
|
|
The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
|
7448 |
|
|
compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
|
7449 |
|
|
fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
|
7450 |
|
|
to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
|
7451 |
|
|
of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
|
7452 |
|
|
that invokes the routines we need at startup.
|
7453 |
|
|
|
7454 |
|
|
To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
|
7455 |
|
|
macro properly.
|
7456 |
|
|
|
7457 |
|
|
If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
|
7458 |
|
|
@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
|
7459 |
|
|
entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
|
7460 |
|
|
it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
|
7461 |
|
|
after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
|
7462 |
|
|
in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
|
7463 |
|
|
|
7464 |
|
|
In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
|
7465 |
|
|
two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
|
7466 |
|
|
and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
|
7467 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
|
7468 |
|
|
entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
|
7469 |
|
|
and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
|
7470 |
|
|
code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
|
7471 |
|
|
the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
|
7472 |
|
|
placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
|
7473 |
|
|
a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
|
7474 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
|
7475 |
|
|
section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
|
7476 |
|
|
the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
|
7477 |
|
|
the initialization process.
|
7478 |
|
|
|
7479 |
|
|
The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
|
7480 |
|
|
This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
|
7481 |
|
|
file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
|
7482 |
|
|
this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
|
7483 |
|
|
termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
|
7484 |
|
|
an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
|
7485 |
|
|
pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
|
7486 |
|
|
the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
|
7487 |
|
|
initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
|
7488 |
|
|
via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
|
7489 |
|
|
@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
|
7490 |
|
|
|
7491 |
|
|
@ifinfo
|
7492 |
|
|
The following section describes the specific macros that control and
|
7493 |
|
|
customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
|
7494 |
|
|
@end ifinfo
|
7495 |
|
|
|
7496 |
|
|
@node Macros for Initialization
|
7497 |
|
|
@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
|
7498 |
|
|
|
7499 |
|
|
Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
|
7500 |
|
|
and termination functions:
|
7501 |
|
|
|
7502 |
|
|
@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
7503 |
|
|
If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
|
7504 |
|
|
operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
|
7505 |
|
|
defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
|
7506 |
|
|
using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
|
7507 |
|
|
macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
|
7508 |
|
|
run the initialization functions.
|
7509 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7510 |
|
|
|
7511 |
|
|
@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
|
7512 |
|
|
If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
|
7513 |
|
|
This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
|
7514 |
|
|
on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
|
7515 |
|
|
be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
|
7516 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7517 |
|
|
|
7518 |
|
|
@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
|
7519 |
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
|
7520 |
|
|
the following symbol is an initialization routine.
|
7521 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7522 |
|
|
|
7523 |
|
|
@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
|
7524 |
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
|
7525 |
|
|
the following symbol is a finalization routine.
|
7526 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7527 |
|
|
|
7528 |
|
|
@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
|
7529 |
|
|
If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
|
7530 |
|
|
automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
|
7531 |
|
|
should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
|
7532 |
|
|
the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
|
7533 |
|
|
function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
|
7534 |
|
|
|
7535 |
|
|
This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
|
7536 |
|
|
shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
|
7537 |
|
|
exception tables embedded in the code.
|
7538 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7539 |
|
|
|
7540 |
|
|
@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
|
7541 |
|
|
If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
|
7542 |
|
|
automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
|
7543 |
|
|
should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
|
7544 |
|
|
the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
|
7545 |
|
|
function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
|
7546 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7547 |
|
|
|
7548 |
|
|
@defmac INVOKE__main
|
7549 |
|
|
If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
|
7550 |
|
|
@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
|
7551 |
|
|
where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
|
7552 |
|
|
useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
|
7553 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7554 |
|
|
|
7555 |
|
|
@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
|
7556 |
|
|
If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
|
7557 |
|
|
compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
|
7558 |
|
|
of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
|
7559 |
|
|
encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
|
7560 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7561 |
|
|
|
7562 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
|
7563 |
|
|
This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
|
7564 |
|
|
collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
|
7565 |
|
|
It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
|
7566 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7567 |
|
|
|
7568 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
|
7569 |
|
|
If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
|
7570 |
|
|
the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
|
7571 |
|
|
|
7572 |
|
|
Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
|
7573 |
|
|
no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
|
7574 |
|
|
priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
|
7575 |
|
|
otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
|
7576 |
|
|
|
7577 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
|
7578 |
|
|
be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
|
7579 |
|
|
target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
|
7580 |
|
|
is not defined.
|
7581 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7582 |
|
|
|
7583 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
|
7584 |
|
|
This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
|
7585 |
|
|
functions rather than initialization functions.
|
7586 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7587 |
|
|
|
7588 |
|
|
If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
|
7589 |
|
|
generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
|
7590 |
|
|
|
7591 |
|
|
If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
|
7592 |
|
|
constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
|
7593 |
|
|
an object file for constructor functions to be called.
|
7594 |
|
|
|
7595 |
|
|
On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
|
7596 |
|
|
@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
|
7597 |
|
|
|
7598 |
|
|
@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
|
7599 |
|
|
Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
|
7600 |
|
|
object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
|
7601 |
|
|
object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
|
7602 |
|
|
|
7603 |
|
|
This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
|
7604 |
|
|
part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
|
7605 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7606 |
|
|
|
7607 |
|
|
@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
|
7608 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
|
7609 |
|
|
to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
|
7610 |
|
|
@command{nm}.
|
7611 |
|
|
|
7612 |
|
|
If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
|
7613 |
|
|
dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
|
7614 |
|
|
these macros to enable support for running initialization and
|
7615 |
|
|
termination functions in shared libraries:
|
7616 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7617 |
|
|
|
7618 |
|
|
@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
|
7619 |
|
|
Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
|
7620 |
|
|
which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
|
7621 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7622 |
|
|
|
7623 |
|
|
@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
|
7624 |
|
|
Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
|
7625 |
|
|
of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
|
7626 |
|
|
of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
|
7627 |
|
|
from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
|
7628 |
|
|
code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
|
7629 |
|
|
line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
|
7630 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7631 |
|
|
|
7632 |
|
|
@node Instruction Output
|
7633 |
|
|
@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
|
7634 |
|
|
|
7635 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
7636 |
|
|
This describes assembler instruction output.
|
7637 |
|
|
|
7638 |
|
|
@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
|
7639 |
|
|
A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
|
7640 |
|
|
registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
|
7641 |
|
|
register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
|
7642 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7643 |
|
|
|
7644 |
|
|
@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
|
7645 |
|
|
If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
|
7646 |
|
|
and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
|
7647 |
|
|
registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
|
7648 |
|
|
to registers using alternate names.
|
7649 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7650 |
|
|
|
7651 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
|
7652 |
|
|
Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
|
7653 |
|
|
requires different names for the machine instructions.
|
7654 |
|
|
|
7655 |
|
|
The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
|
7656 |
|
|
assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
|
7657 |
|
|
macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
|
7658 |
|
|
points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
|
7659 |
|
|
written in the machine description. The definition should output the
|
7660 |
|
|
opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
|
7661 |
|
|
increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
|
7662 |
|
|
so that it will not be output twice.
|
7663 |
|
|
|
7664 |
|
|
In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
|
7665 |
|
|
name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
|
7666 |
|
|
that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
|
7667 |
|
|
care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
|
7668 |
|
|
@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
|
7669 |
|
|
|
7670 |
|
|
@findex recog_data.operand
|
7671 |
|
|
If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
|
7672 |
|
|
elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
|
7673 |
|
|
|
7674 |
|
|
If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
|
7675 |
|
|
in the usual way.
|
7676 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7677 |
|
|
|
7678 |
|
|
@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
|
7679 |
|
|
If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
|
7680 |
|
|
assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
|
7681 |
|
|
they will be output differently.
|
7682 |
|
|
|
7683 |
|
|
Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
|
7684 |
|
|
extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
|
7685 |
|
|
elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
|
7686 |
|
|
The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
|
7687 |
|
|
template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
|
7688 |
|
|
by changing the contents of the vector.
|
7689 |
|
|
|
7690 |
|
|
This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
|
7691 |
|
|
file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
|
7692 |
|
|
can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
|
7693 |
|
|
as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
|
7694 |
|
|
syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
|
7695 |
|
|
writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
|
7696 |
|
|
|
7697 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
|
7698 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7699 |
|
|
|
7700 |
|
|
@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
|
7701 |
|
|
A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
|
7702 |
|
|
assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
|
7703 |
|
|
RTL expression.
|
7704 |
|
|
|
7705 |
|
|
@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
|
7706 |
|
|
of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
|
7707 |
|
|
printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
|
7708 |
|
|
the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
|
7709 |
|
|
operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
|
7710 |
|
|
@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
|
7711 |
|
|
@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
|
7712 |
|
|
|
7713 |
|
|
@findex reg_names
|
7714 |
|
|
If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
|
7715 |
|
|
The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
|
7716 |
|
|
@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
|
7717 |
|
|
@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
|
7718 |
|
|
|
7719 |
|
|
When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
|
7720 |
|
|
(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
|
7721 |
|
|
with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
|
7722 |
|
|
@var{code}.
|
7723 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7724 |
|
|
|
7725 |
|
|
@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
|
7726 |
|
|
A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
|
7727 |
|
|
punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
|
7728 |
|
|
@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
|
7729 |
|
|
punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
|
7730 |
|
|
in this way.
|
7731 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7732 |
|
|
|
7733 |
|
|
@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
|
7734 |
|
|
A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
|
7735 |
|
|
assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
|
7736 |
|
|
whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
|
7737 |
|
|
|
7738 |
|
|
@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
|
7739 |
|
|
On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
|
7740 |
|
|
section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
|
7741 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
|
7742 |
|
|
@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
|
7743 |
|
|
Format}.
|
7744 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7745 |
|
|
|
7746 |
|
|
@findex dbr_sequence_length
|
7747 |
|
|
@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
|
7748 |
|
|
A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
|
7749 |
|
|
been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
|
7750 |
|
|
determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
|
7751 |
|
|
currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
|
7752 |
|
|
or whatever.
|
7753 |
|
|
|
7754 |
|
|
Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
|
7755 |
|
|
reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
|
7756 |
|
|
explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
|
7757 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7758 |
|
|
|
7759 |
|
|
@findex final_sequence
|
7760 |
|
|
Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
|
7761 |
|
|
prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
|
7762 |
|
|
(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
|
7763 |
|
|
found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
|
7764 |
|
|
processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
|
7765 |
|
|
being output.
|
7766 |
|
|
|
7767 |
|
|
@findex asm_fprintf
|
7768 |
|
|
@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
|
7769 |
|
|
@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
|
7770 |
|
|
@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
|
7771 |
|
|
@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
|
7772 |
|
|
If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
|
7773 |
|
|
@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
|
7774 |
|
|
@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
|
7775 |
|
|
support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
|
7776 |
|
|
files can define these macros differently.
|
7777 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7778 |
|
|
|
7779 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
|
7780 |
|
|
If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
|
7781 |
|
|
statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
|
7782 |
|
|
the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
|
7783 |
|
|
printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
|
7784 |
|
|
statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
|
7785 |
|
|
generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
|
7786 |
|
|
specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
|
7787 |
|
|
The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
|
7788 |
|
|
string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
|
7789 |
|
|
upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
|
7790 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7791 |
|
|
|
7792 |
|
|
@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
|
7793 |
|
|
If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
|
7794 |
|
|
different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
|
7795 |
|
|
numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
|
7796 |
|
|
first variant.
|
7797 |
|
|
|
7798 |
|
|
If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
|
7799 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
7800 |
|
|
@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
|
7801 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
7802 |
|
|
@noindent
|
7803 |
|
|
in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
|
7804 |
|
|
first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
|
7805 |
|
|
@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
|
7806 |
|
|
@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
|
7807 |
|
|
within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
|
7808 |
|
|
alternatives within the braces than the value of
|
7809 |
|
|
@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
|
7810 |
|
|
|
7811 |
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
|
7812 |
|
|
@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
|
7813 |
|
|
operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
|
7814 |
|
|
|
7815 |
|
|
Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
|
7816 |
|
|
@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
|
7817 |
|
|
the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
|
7818 |
|
|
@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
|
7819 |
|
|
if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
|
7820 |
|
|
opcodes or operand order.
|
7821 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7822 |
|
|
|
7823 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
|
7824 |
|
|
A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
|
7825 |
|
|
which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
|
7826 |
|
|
The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
|
7827 |
|
|
profiling.
|
7828 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7829 |
|
|
|
7830 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
|
7831 |
|
|
A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
|
7832 |
|
|
which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
|
7833 |
|
|
The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
|
7834 |
|
|
profiling.
|
7835 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7836 |
|
|
|
7837 |
|
|
@node Dispatch Tables
|
7838 |
|
|
@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
|
7839 |
|
|
|
7840 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
7841 |
|
|
This concerns dispatch tables.
|
7842 |
|
|
|
7843 |
|
|
@cindex dispatch table
|
7844 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
|
7845 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
7846 |
|
|
pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
|
7847 |
|
|
@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
|
7848 |
|
|
definitions of these labels are output using
|
7849 |
|
|
@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
|
7850 |
|
|
way here. For example,
|
7851 |
|
|
|
7852 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
7853 |
|
|
fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
|
7854 |
|
|
@var{value}, @var{rel})
|
7855 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
7856 |
|
|
|
7857 |
|
|
You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
|
7858 |
|
|
dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
|
7859 |
|
|
will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
|
7860 |
|
|
@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
|
7861 |
|
|
mode and flags can be read.
|
7862 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7863 |
|
|
|
7864 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
7865 |
|
|
This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
|
7866 |
|
|
in a dispatch table are absolute.
|
7867 |
|
|
|
7868 |
|
|
The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
|
7869 |
|
|
@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
|
7870 |
|
|
a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
|
7871 |
|
|
definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
|
7872 |
|
|
For example,
|
7873 |
|
|
|
7874 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
7875 |
|
|
fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
|
7876 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
7877 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7878 |
|
|
|
7879 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
|
7880 |
|
|
Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
|
7881 |
|
|
specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
|
7882 |
|
|
@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
|
7883 |
|
|
jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
|
7884 |
|
|
@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
|
7885 |
|
|
|
7886 |
|
|
This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
|
7887 |
|
|
for the table.
|
7888 |
|
|
|
7889 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
|
7890 |
|
|
@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
|
7891 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7892 |
|
|
|
7893 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
|
7894 |
|
|
Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
|
7895 |
|
|
jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
|
7896 |
|
|
after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
|
7897 |
|
|
the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
|
7898 |
|
|
@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
|
7899 |
|
|
of the preceding label.
|
7900 |
|
|
|
7901 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
|
7902 |
|
|
the jump-table.
|
7903 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7904 |
|
|
|
7905 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{for_eh}, @var{empty})
|
7906 |
|
|
This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
|
7907 |
|
|
should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
|
7908 |
|
|
should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
|
7909 |
|
|
function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
|
7910 |
|
|
The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
|
7911 |
|
|
exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
|
7912 |
|
|
true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
|
7913 |
|
|
|
7914 |
|
|
The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
|
7915 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7916 |
|
|
|
7917 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (@var{stream})
|
7918 |
|
|
This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
|
7919 |
|
|
It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
|
7920 |
|
|
to be broken up according to function.
|
7921 |
|
|
|
7922 |
|
|
The default is that no label is emitted.
|
7923 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7924 |
|
|
|
7925 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE * @var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
|
7926 |
|
|
This target hook emits and assembly directives required to unwind the
|
7927 |
|
|
given instruction. This is only used when TARGET_UNWIND_INFO is set.
|
7928 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
7929 |
|
|
|
7930 |
|
|
@node Exception Region Output
|
7931 |
|
|
@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
|
7932 |
|
|
|
7933 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
7934 |
|
|
|
7935 |
|
|
This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
|
7936 |
|
|
region.
|
7937 |
|
|
|
7938 |
|
|
@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
|
7939 |
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
|
7940 |
|
|
exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
|
7941 |
|
|
provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
|
7942 |
|
|
@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
|
7943 |
|
|
|
7944 |
|
|
You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
|
7945 |
|
|
unwind information and the default definition does not work.
|
7946 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7947 |
|
|
|
7948 |
|
|
@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
|
7949 |
|
|
If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
|
7950 |
|
|
data section even though the target supports named sections. This
|
7951 |
|
|
might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
|
7952 |
|
|
collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
|
7953 |
|
|
|
7954 |
|
|
Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
|
7955 |
|
|
also defined.
|
7956 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7957 |
|
|
|
7958 |
|
|
@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
|
7959 |
|
|
Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
|
7960 |
|
|
information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
|
7961 |
|
|
runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
|
7962 |
|
|
and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
|
7963 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7964 |
|
|
|
7965 |
|
|
@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
|
7966 |
|
|
An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
|
7967 |
|
|
that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
|
7968 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7969 |
|
|
|
7970 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
|
7971 |
|
|
Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
|
7972 |
|
|
information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
|
7973 |
|
|
Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
|
7974 |
|
|
@samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
|
7975 |
|
|
or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
|
7976 |
|
|
|
7977 |
|
|
If @code{TARGET_UNWIND_INFO} is defined, the target specific unwinder
|
7978 |
|
|
will be used in all cases. Defining this macro will enable the generation
|
7979 |
|
|
of DWARF 2 frame debugging information.
|
7980 |
|
|
|
7981 |
|
|
If @code{TARGET_UNWIND_INFO} is not defined, and this macro is defined to 1,
|
7982 |
|
|
the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default exception handling mechanism;
|
7983 |
|
|
otherwise, the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme will be used by
|
7984 |
|
|
default.
|
7985 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7986 |
|
|
|
7987 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
|
7988 |
|
|
Define this macro if your target has ABI specified unwind tables. Usually
|
7989 |
|
|
these will be output by @code{TARGET_UNWIND_EMIT}.
|
7990 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
7991 |
|
|
|
7992 |
|
|
@deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
|
7993 |
|
|
This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
|
7994 |
|
|
tables even when exceptions are not used.
|
7995 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
7996 |
|
|
|
7997 |
|
|
@defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
|
7998 |
|
|
This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
|
7999 |
|
|
runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
|
8000 |
|
|
determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
|
8001 |
|
|
so the target must provide it directly.
|
8002 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8003 |
|
|
|
8004 |
|
|
@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
|
8005 |
|
|
Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
|
8006 |
|
|
should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
|
8007 |
|
|
instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
|
8008 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8009 |
|
|
|
8010 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
|
8011 |
|
|
This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
|
8012 |
|
|
function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
|
8013 |
|
|
@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
|
8014 |
|
|
alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
|
8015 |
|
|
minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
|
8016 |
|
|
the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
|
8017 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8018 |
|
|
|
8019 |
|
|
@deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
|
8020 |
|
|
Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
|
8021 |
|
|
end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
|
8022 |
|
|
Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
|
8023 |
|
|
true otherwise.
|
8024 |
|
|
@end deftypevar
|
8025 |
|
|
|
8026 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
|
8027 |
|
|
Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
|
8028 |
|
|
represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
|
8029 |
|
|
register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
|
8030 |
|
|
locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
|
8031 |
|
|
register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
|
8032 |
|
|
If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
|
8033 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8034 |
|
|
|
8035 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
|
8036 |
|
|
This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
|
8037 |
|
|
the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
|
8038 |
|
|
if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
|
8039 |
|
|
reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
|
8040 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8041 |
|
|
|
8042 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
|
8043 |
|
|
This hook should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
|
8044 |
|
|
based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
|
8045 |
|
|
the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
|
8046 |
|
|
running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
|
8047 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8048 |
|
|
|
8049 |
|
|
@node Alignment Output
|
8050 |
|
|
@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
|
8051 |
|
|
|
8052 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
8053 |
|
|
This describes commands for alignment.
|
8054 |
|
|
|
8055 |
|
|
@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
|
8056 |
|
|
The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
|
8057 |
|
|
a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
|
8058 |
|
|
|
8059 |
|
|
This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
|
8060 |
|
|
to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
|
8061 |
|
|
define the macro.
|
8062 |
|
|
|
8063 |
|
|
Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
|
8064 |
|
|
to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
|
8065 |
|
|
@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
|
8066 |
|
|
selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
|
8067 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8068 |
|
|
|
8069 |
|
|
@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
|
8070 |
|
|
The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
|
8071 |
|
|
a @code{BARRIER}.
|
8072 |
|
|
|
8073 |
|
|
This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
|
8074 |
|
|
to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
|
8075 |
|
|
define the macro.
|
8076 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8077 |
|
|
|
8078 |
|
|
@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
|
8079 |
|
|
The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
|
8080 |
|
|
@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
|
8081 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
|
8082 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8083 |
|
|
|
8084 |
|
|
@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
|
8085 |
|
|
The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
|
8086 |
|
|
a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
|
8087 |
|
|
|
8088 |
|
|
This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
|
8089 |
|
|
to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
|
8090 |
|
|
define the macro.
|
8091 |
|
|
|
8092 |
|
|
Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
|
8093 |
|
|
to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
|
8094 |
|
|
@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
|
8095 |
|
|
selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
|
8096 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8097 |
|
|
|
8098 |
|
|
@defmac LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
|
8099 |
|
|
The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
|
8100 |
|
|
This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
|
8101 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8102 |
|
|
|
8103 |
|
|
@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
|
8104 |
|
|
The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
|
8105 |
|
|
If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
|
8106 |
|
|
the maximum of the specified values is used.
|
8107 |
|
|
|
8108 |
|
|
Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
|
8109 |
|
|
to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
|
8110 |
|
|
@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
|
8111 |
|
|
selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
|
8112 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8113 |
|
|
|
8114 |
|
|
@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
|
8115 |
|
|
The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
|
8116 |
|
|
This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
|
8117 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8118 |
|
|
|
8119 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
|
8120 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
8121 |
|
|
instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
|
8122 |
|
|
Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
|
8123 |
|
|
expression of type @code{int}.
|
8124 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8125 |
|
|
|
8126 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
|
8127 |
|
|
Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
|
8128 |
|
|
text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
|
8129 |
|
|
This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
|
8130 |
|
|
produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
|
8131 |
|
|
section.
|
8132 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8133 |
|
|
|
8134 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
|
8135 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
8136 |
|
|
command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
|
8137 |
|
|
@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
|
8138 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8139 |
|
|
|
8140 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
|
8141 |
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
|
8142 |
|
|
for padding, if necessary.
|
8143 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8144 |
|
|
|
8145 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
|
8146 |
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
8147 |
|
|
command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
|
8148 |
|
|
@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
|
8149 |
|
|
satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
|
8150 |
|
|
a C expression of type @code{int}.
|
8151 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8152 |
|
|
|
8153 |
|
|
@need 3000
|
8154 |
|
|
@node Debugging Info
|
8155 |
|
|
@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
|
8156 |
|
|
|
8157 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
8158 |
|
|
This describes how to specify debugging information.
|
8159 |
|
|
|
8160 |
|
|
@menu
|
8161 |
|
|
* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
|
8162 |
|
|
* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
|
8163 |
|
|
* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
|
8164 |
|
|
* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
|
8165 |
|
|
* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
|
8166 |
|
|
* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
|
8167 |
|
|
@end menu
|
8168 |
|
|
|
8169 |
|
|
@node All Debuggers
|
8170 |
|
|
@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
|
8171 |
|
|
|
8172 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
8173 |
|
|
These macros affect all debugging formats.
|
8174 |
|
|
|
8175 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
|
8176 |
|
|
A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
|
8177 |
|
|
register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
|
8178 |
|
|
of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
|
8179 |
|
|
some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
|
8180 |
|
|
versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
|
8181 |
|
|
compiler and another for DBX@.
|
8182 |
|
|
|
8183 |
|
|
If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
|
8184 |
|
|
used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
|
8185 |
|
|
consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
|
8186 |
|
|
Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
|
8187 |
|
|
expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
|
8188 |
|
|
|
8189 |
|
|
If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
|
8190 |
|
|
does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
|
8191 |
|
|
redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
|
8192 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8193 |
|
|
|
8194 |
|
|
@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
|
8195 |
|
|
A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
|
8196 |
|
|
variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
|
8197 |
|
|
computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
|
8198 |
|
|
gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
|
8199 |
|
|
that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
|
8200 |
|
|
for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
|
8201 |
|
|
@option{-g} options is used.
|
8202 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8203 |
|
|
|
8204 |
|
|
@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
|
8205 |
|
|
A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
|
8206 |
|
|
having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
|
8207 |
|
|
@var{offset}.
|
8208 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8209 |
|
|
|
8210 |
|
|
@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
|
8211 |
|
|
A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
|
8212 |
|
|
produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
|
8213 |
|
|
this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
|
8214 |
|
|
debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
|
8215 |
|
|
@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
|
8216 |
|
|
@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
|
8217 |
|
|
|
8218 |
|
|
When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
|
8219 |
|
|
value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
|
8220 |
|
|
exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
|
8221 |
|
|
value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
|
8222 |
|
|
defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
|
8223 |
|
|
|
8224 |
|
|
The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
|
8225 |
|
|
user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
|
8226 |
|
|
@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
|
8227 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8228 |
|
|
|
8229 |
|
|
@node DBX Options
|
8230 |
|
|
@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
|
8231 |
|
|
|
8232 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
8233 |
|
|
These are specific options for DBX output.
|
8234 |
|
|
|
8235 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
8236 |
|
|
Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
|
8237 |
|
|
in response to the @option{-g} option.
|
8238 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8239 |
|
|
|
8240 |
|
|
@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
8241 |
|
|
Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
|
8242 |
|
|
in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
|
8243 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8244 |
|
|
|
8245 |
|
|
@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
|
8246 |
|
|
Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
|
8247 |
|
|
GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
|
8248 |
|
|
debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
|
8249 |
|
|
macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
|
8250 |
|
|
if there is any occasion to.
|
8251 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8252 |
|
|
|
8253 |
|
|
@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
|
8254 |
|
|
Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
|
8255 |
|
|
in the text section.
|
8256 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8257 |
|
|
|
8258 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
|
8259 |
|
|
A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
|
8260 |
|
|
use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
|
8261 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
|
8262 |
|
|
applies only to DBX debugging information format.
|
8263 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8264 |
|
|
|
8265 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
|
8266 |
|
|
A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
|
8267 |
|
|
use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
|
8268 |
|
|
value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
|
8269 |
|
|
@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
|
8270 |
|
|
information format.
|
8271 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8272 |
|
|
|
8273 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
|
8274 |
|
|
A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
|
8275 |
|
|
use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
|
8276 |
|
|
name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
|
8277 |
|
|
macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
|
8278 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8279 |
|
|
|
8280 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
|
8281 |
|
|
Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
|
8282 |
|
|
@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
|
8283 |
|
|
describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
|
8284 |
|
|
On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
|
8285 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8286 |
|
|
|
8287 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
|
8288 |
|
|
A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
|
8289 |
|
|
continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
|
8290 |
|
|
exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
|
8291 |
|
|
operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
|
8292 |
|
|
must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
|
8293 |
|
|
with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
|
8294 |
|
|
defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
|
8295 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8296 |
|
|
|
8297 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
|
8298 |
|
|
Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
|
8299 |
|
|
the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
|
8300 |
|
|
a different character instead, define this macro as a character
|
8301 |
|
|
constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
|
8302 |
|
|
if backslash is correct for your system.
|
8303 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8304 |
|
|
|
8305 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
|
8306 |
|
|
Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
|
8307 |
|
|
outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
|
8308 |
|
|
variable.
|
8309 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8310 |
|
|
|
8311 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
|
8312 |
|
|
The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
|
8313 |
|
|
for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
|
8314 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8315 |
|
|
|
8316 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
|
8317 |
|
|
The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
|
8318 |
|
|
for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
|
8319 |
|
|
provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
|
8320 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8321 |
|
|
|
8322 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
|
8323 |
|
|
The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
|
8324 |
|
|
for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
|
8325 |
|
|
``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
|
8326 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8327 |
|
|
|
8328 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
|
8329 |
|
|
The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
|
8330 |
|
|
passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
|
8331 |
|
|
do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
|
8332 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8333 |
|
|
|
8334 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
|
8335 |
|
|
Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
|
8336 |
|
|
arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
|
8337 |
|
|
in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
|
8338 |
|
|
code.
|
8339 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8340 |
|
|
|
8341 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
|
8342 |
|
|
Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
|
8343 |
|
|
the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
|
8344 |
|
|
relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
|
8345 |
|
|
an absolute address.
|
8346 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8347 |
|
|
|
8348 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
|
8349 |
|
|
Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
|
8350 |
|
|
the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
|
8351 |
|
|
start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
|
8352 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8353 |
|
|
|
8354 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
|
8355 |
|
|
Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
|
8356 |
|
|
@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
|
8357 |
|
|
macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
|
8358 |
|
|
number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
|
8359 |
|
|
generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
|
8360 |
|
|
number for a type number.
|
8361 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8362 |
|
|
|
8363 |
|
|
@node DBX Hooks
|
8364 |
|
|
@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
|
8365 |
|
|
|
8366 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
8367 |
|
|
These are hooks for DBX format.
|
8368 |
|
|
|
8369 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
8370 |
|
|
Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
|
8371 |
|
|
information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
|
8372 |
|
|
argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
|
8373 |
|
|
@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
|
8374 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8375 |
|
|
|
8376 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
8377 |
|
|
Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
|
8378 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8379 |
|
|
|
8380 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
|
8381 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
|
8382 |
|
|
output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
|
8383 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8384 |
|
|
|
8385 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
|
8386 |
|
|
A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
|
8387 |
|
|
number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
|
8388 |
|
|
@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
|
8389 |
|
|
invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
|
8390 |
|
|
unique labels in the assembly output.
|
8391 |
|
|
|
8392 |
|
|
This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
|
8393 |
|
|
if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
|
8394 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8395 |
|
|
|
8396 |
|
|
@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
|
8397 |
|
|
Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
|
8398 |
|
|
@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
|
8399 |
|
|
On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
|
8400 |
|
|
disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
|
8401 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8402 |
|
|
|
8403 |
|
|
@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
|
8404 |
|
|
Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
|
8405 |
|
|
extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
|
8406 |
|
|
feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
|
8407 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8408 |
|
|
|
8409 |
|
|
@node File Names and DBX
|
8410 |
|
|
@subsection File Names in DBX Format
|
8411 |
|
|
|
8412 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
8413 |
|
|
This describes file names in DBX format.
|
8414 |
|
|
|
8415 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
8416 |
|
|
A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
|
8417 |
|
|
@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
|
8418 |
|
|
file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
|
8419 |
|
|
This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
|
8420 |
|
|
|
8421 |
|
|
This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
|
8422 |
|
|
for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
|
8423 |
|
|
|
8424 |
|
|
It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
|
8425 |
|
|
text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
|
8426 |
|
|
to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
|
8427 |
|
|
@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
|
8428 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8429 |
|
|
|
8430 |
|
|
@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
|
8431 |
|
|
Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
|
8432 |
|
|
of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
|
8433 |
|
|
the beginning of the file.
|
8434 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8435 |
|
|
|
8436 |
|
|
@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
|
8437 |
|
|
Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
|
8438 |
|
|
that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
|
8439 |
|
|
an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
|
8440 |
|
|
@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
|
8441 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8442 |
|
|
|
8443 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
8444 |
|
|
A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
|
8445 |
|
|
compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
|
8446 |
|
|
written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
|
8447 |
|
|
|
8448 |
|
|
If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
|
8449 |
|
|
of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
|
8450 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8451 |
|
|
|
8452 |
|
|
@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
|
8453 |
|
|
Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
|
8454 |
|
|
@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
|
8455 |
|
|
the end of compilation is a @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
|
8456 |
|
|
whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
|
8457 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8458 |
|
|
|
8459 |
|
|
@need 2000
|
8460 |
|
|
@node SDB and DWARF
|
8461 |
|
|
@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
|
8462 |
|
|
|
8463 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
8464 |
|
|
Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
|
8465 |
|
|
|
8466 |
|
|
@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
8467 |
|
|
Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
|
8468 |
|
|
for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
|
8469 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8470 |
|
|
|
8471 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
8472 |
|
|
Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
|
8473 |
|
|
debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
|
8474 |
|
|
|
8475 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (tree @var{function})
|
8476 |
|
|
Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
|
8477 |
|
|
be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
|
8478 |
|
|
value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
|
8479 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8480 |
|
|
|
8481 |
|
|
To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
|
8482 |
|
|
define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
|
8483 |
|
|
@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
|
8484 |
|
|
prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
|
8485 |
|
|
as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
|
8486 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8487 |
|
|
|
8488 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
|
8489 |
|
|
Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
|
8490 |
|
|
Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
|
8491 |
|
|
(@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
|
8492 |
|
|
information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
|
8493 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8494 |
|
|
|
8495 |
|
|
@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
|
8496 |
|
|
Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
|
8497 |
|
|
line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
|
8498 |
|
|
tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
|
8499 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8500 |
|
|
|
8501 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
|
8502 |
|
|
A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
|
8503 |
|
|
@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
|
8504 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8505 |
|
|
|
8506 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
|
8507 |
|
|
A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
|
8508 |
|
|
section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
|
8509 |
|
|
given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
|
8510 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8511 |
|
|
|
8512 |
|
|
@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
|
8513 |
|
|
A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
|
8514 |
|
|
reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
|
8515 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8516 |
|
|
|
8517 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{FILE}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
|
8518 |
|
|
If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
|
8519 |
|
|
reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
|
8520 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8521 |
|
|
|
8522 |
|
|
@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
|
8523 |
|
|
Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
|
8524 |
|
|
SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
|
8525 |
|
|
macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
|
8526 |
|
|
not define them yourself.
|
8527 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8528 |
|
|
|
8529 |
|
|
@defmac SDB_DELIM
|
8530 |
|
|
Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
|
8531 |
|
|
SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
|
8532 |
|
|
delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
|
8533 |
|
|
a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
|
8534 |
|
|
required.
|
8535 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8536 |
|
|
|
8537 |
|
|
@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
|
8538 |
|
|
Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
|
8539 |
|
|
union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
|
8540 |
|
|
allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
|
8541 |
|
|
it.
|
8542 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8543 |
|
|
|
8544 |
|
|
@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
|
8545 |
|
|
Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
|
8546 |
|
|
enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
|
8547 |
|
|
assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
|
8548 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8549 |
|
|
|
8550 |
|
|
@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
|
8551 |
|
|
A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
|
8552 |
|
|
number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
|
8553 |
|
|
@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
|
8554 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8555 |
|
|
|
8556 |
|
|
@need 2000
|
8557 |
|
|
@node VMS Debug
|
8558 |
|
|
@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
|
8559 |
|
|
|
8560 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
8561 |
|
|
Here are macros for VMS debug format.
|
8562 |
|
|
|
8563 |
|
|
@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
8564 |
|
|
Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
|
8565 |
|
|
in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
|
8566 |
|
|
is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
|
8567 |
|
|
@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
|
8568 |
|
|
behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
|
8569 |
|
|
@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.
|
8570 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8571 |
|
|
|
8572 |
|
|
@node Floating Point
|
8573 |
|
|
@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
|
8574 |
|
|
@cindex cross compilation and floating point
|
8575 |
|
|
@cindex floating point and cross compilation
|
8576 |
|
|
|
8577 |
|
|
While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
|
8578 |
|
|
there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
|
8579 |
|
|
means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
|
8580 |
|
|
in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
|
8581 |
|
|
doing the compilation.
|
8582 |
|
|
|
8583 |
|
|
Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
|
8584 |
|
|
range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
|
8585 |
|
|
the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
|
8586 |
|
|
safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
|
8587 |
|
|
the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
|
8588 |
|
|
emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
|
8589 |
|
|
target floating point formats are identical.
|
8590 |
|
|
|
8591 |
|
|
The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
|
8592 |
|
|
use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
|
8593 |
|
|
floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
|
8594 |
|
|
their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
|
8595 |
|
|
|
8596 |
|
|
@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
|
8597 |
|
|
The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
|
8598 |
|
|
machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
|
8599 |
|
|
array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
|
8600 |
|
|
quantity.
|
8601 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8602 |
|
|
|
8603 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
|
8604 |
|
|
Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
|
8605 |
|
|
floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
|
8606 |
|
|
@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
|
8607 |
|
|
@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
|
8608 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8609 |
|
|
|
8610 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
|
8611 |
|
|
Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
|
8612 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8613 |
|
|
|
8614 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
|
8615 |
|
|
Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
|
8616 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8617 |
|
|
|
8618 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
|
8619 |
|
|
Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
|
8620 |
|
|
@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
|
8621 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8622 |
|
|
|
8623 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
|
8624 |
|
|
Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
|
8625 |
|
|
representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
|
8626 |
|
|
decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
|
8627 |
|
|
defined by the C language for both.
|
8628 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8629 |
|
|
|
8630 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
|
8631 |
|
|
Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
|
8632 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8633 |
|
|
|
8634 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
|
8635 |
|
|
Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
|
8636 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8637 |
|
|
|
8638 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
|
8639 |
|
|
Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
|
8640 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8641 |
|
|
|
8642 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
|
8643 |
|
|
Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
|
8644 |
|
|
@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
|
8645 |
|
|
variable).
|
8646 |
|
|
|
8647 |
|
|
The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
|
8648 |
|
|
following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
|
8649 |
|
|
@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
|
8650 |
|
|
|
8651 |
|
|
If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
|
8652 |
|
|
target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
|
8653 |
|
|
@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
|
8654 |
|
|
@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
|
8655 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8656 |
|
|
|
8657 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
|
8658 |
|
|
Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
|
8659 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8660 |
|
|
|
8661 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
|
8662 |
|
|
Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
|
8663 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8664 |
|
|
|
8665 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
|
8666 |
|
|
Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
|
8667 |
|
|
return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
|
8668 |
|
|
appropriate bit pattern to be output asa floating constant whose
|
8669 |
|
|
precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
|
8670 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8671 |
|
|
|
8672 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
|
8673 |
|
|
Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
|
8674 |
|
|
which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
|
8675 |
|
|
integral, it is truncated.
|
8676 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8677 |
|
|
|
8678 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
|
8679 |
|
|
Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
|
8680 |
|
|
into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
|
8681 |
|
|
value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
|
8682 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8683 |
|
|
|
8684 |
|
|
@node Mode Switching
|
8685 |
|
|
@section Mode Switching Instructions
|
8686 |
|
|
@cindex mode switching
|
8687 |
|
|
The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
|
8688 |
|
|
|
8689 |
|
|
@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
|
8690 |
|
|
Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
|
8691 |
|
|
switching in an optimizing compilation.
|
8692 |
|
|
|
8693 |
|
|
For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
|
8694 |
|
|
floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
|
8695 |
|
|
the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
|
8696 |
|
|
operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
|
8697 |
|
|
purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
|
8698 |
|
|
be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
|
8699 |
|
|
or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
|
8700 |
|
|
|
8701 |
|
|
You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
|
8702 |
|
|
which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
|
8703 |
|
|
return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
|
8704 |
|
|
If you define this macro, you also have to define
|
8705 |
|
|
@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
|
8706 |
|
|
@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
|
8707 |
|
|
@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
|
8708 |
|
|
are optional.
|
8709 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8710 |
|
|
|
8711 |
|
|
@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
|
8712 |
|
|
If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
|
8713 |
|
|
initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
|
8714 |
|
|
N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
|
8715 |
|
|
of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
|
8716 |
|
|
The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
|
8717 |
|
|
zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
|
8718 |
|
|
entity in question.
|
8719 |
|
|
In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
|
8720 |
|
|
represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
|
8721 |
|
|
switch is needed / supplied.
|
8722 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8723 |
|
|
|
8724 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
|
8725 |
|
|
@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
|
8726 |
|
|
@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
|
8727 |
|
|
return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
|
8728 |
|
|
@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
|
8729 |
|
|
be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
|
8730 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8731 |
|
|
|
8732 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
|
8733 |
|
|
If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
|
8734 |
|
|
mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
|
8735 |
|
|
different from the incoming mode).
|
8736 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8737 |
|
|
|
8738 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
|
8739 |
|
|
If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
|
8740 |
|
|
mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
|
8741 |
|
|
@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
|
8742 |
|
|
is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
|
8743 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8744 |
|
|
|
8745 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
|
8746 |
|
|
If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
|
8747 |
|
|
mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
|
8748 |
|
|
@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
|
8749 |
|
|
is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
|
8750 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8751 |
|
|
|
8752 |
|
|
@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
|
8753 |
|
|
This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
|
8754 |
|
|
|
8755 |
|
|
lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
|
8756 |
|
|
for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
|
8757 |
|
|
(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
|
8758 |
|
|
@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
|
8759 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8760 |
|
|
|
8761 |
|
|
@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
|
8762 |
|
|
Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
|
8763 |
|
|
@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
|
8764 |
|
|
the insn(s) are to be inserted.
|
8765 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8766 |
|
|
|
8767 |
|
|
@node Target Attributes
|
8768 |
|
|
@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
|
8769 |
|
|
@cindex target attributes
|
8770 |
|
|
@cindex machine attributes
|
8771 |
|
|
@cindex attributes, target-specific
|
8772 |
|
|
|
8773 |
|
|
Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
|
8774 |
|
|
These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
|
8775 |
|
|
be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
|
8776 |
|
|
|
8777 |
|
|
@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
|
8778 |
|
|
If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
|
8779 |
|
|
attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
|
8780 |
|
|
specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
|
8781 |
|
|
entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
|
8782 |
|
|
take.
|
8783 |
|
|
@end deftypevr
|
8784 |
|
|
|
8785 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
|
8786 |
|
|
If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
|
8787 |
|
|
@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
|
8788 |
|
|
and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
|
8789 |
|
|
generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
|
8790 |
|
|
supposed always to be compatible.
|
8791 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8792 |
|
|
|
8793 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
|
8794 |
|
|
If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
|
8795 |
|
|
newly defined @var{type}.
|
8796 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8797 |
|
|
|
8798 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
|
8799 |
|
|
Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
|
8800 |
|
|
handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
|
8801 |
|
|
@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
|
8802 |
|
|
that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
|
8803 |
|
|
function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
|
8804 |
|
|
merging.
|
8805 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8806 |
|
|
|
8807 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
|
8808 |
|
|
Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
|
8809 |
|
|
handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
|
8810 |
|
|
@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
|
8811 |
|
|
@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
|
8812 |
|
|
when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
|
8813 |
|
|
attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
|
8814 |
|
|
call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
|
8815 |
|
|
|
8816 |
|
|
@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
|
8817 |
|
|
If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
|
8818 |
|
|
for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
|
8819 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
|
8820 |
|
|
will then define a function called
|
8821 |
|
|
@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
|
8822 |
|
|
the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
|
8823 |
|
|
add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
|
8824 |
|
|
to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
|
8825 |
|
|
@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
|
8826 |
|
|
@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
|
8827 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8828 |
|
|
|
8829 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{decl})
|
8830 |
|
|
@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))}
|
8831 |
|
|
specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation
|
8832 |
|
|
checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
|
8833 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8834 |
|
|
|
8835 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
|
8836 |
|
|
Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
|
8837 |
|
|
@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
|
8838 |
|
|
default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
|
8839 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
|
8840 |
|
|
of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
|
8841 |
|
|
on this implementation detail.
|
8842 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8843 |
|
|
|
8844 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
|
8845 |
|
|
Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
|
8846 |
|
|
when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
|
8847 |
|
|
wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
|
8848 |
|
|
the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
|
8849 |
|
|
created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
|
8850 |
|
|
for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
|
8851 |
|
|
shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
|
8852 |
|
|
the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
|
8853 |
|
|
attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
|
8854 |
|
|
needed.
|
8855 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8856 |
|
|
|
8857 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (tree @var{fndecl})
|
8858 |
|
|
@cindex inlining
|
8859 |
|
|
This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
|
8860 |
|
|
into the current function, despite its having target-specific
|
8861 |
|
|
attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
|
8862 |
|
|
target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
|
8863 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8864 |
|
|
|
8865 |
|
|
@node MIPS Coprocessors
|
8866 |
|
|
@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
|
8867 |
|
|
@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
|
8868 |
|
|
|
8869 |
|
|
The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
|
8870 |
|
|
coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
|
8871 |
|
|
accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
|
8872 |
|
|
and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
|
8873 |
|
|
|
8874 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
8875 |
|
|
register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
|
8876 |
|
|
unsigned int d;
|
8877 |
|
|
|
8878 |
|
|
d = cp0count + 3;
|
8879 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
8880 |
|
|
|
8881 |
|
|
(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
|
8882 |
|
|
names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
|
8883 |
|
|
overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
|
8884 |
|
|
|
8885 |
|
|
Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
|
8886 |
|
|
be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
|
8887 |
|
|
later in the function.
|
8888 |
|
|
|
8889 |
|
|
Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
|
8890 |
|
|
the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
|
8891 |
|
|
floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
|
8892 |
|
|
|
8893 |
|
|
There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
|
8894 |
|
|
you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
|
8895 |
|
|
|
8896 |
|
|
@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
|
8897 |
|
|
A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
|
8898 |
|
|
alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
|
8899 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
8900 |
|
|
@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
|
8901 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
8902 |
|
|
Default: empty.
|
8903 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
8904 |
|
|
|
8905 |
|
|
@node PCH Target
|
8906 |
|
|
@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
|
8907 |
|
|
@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
|
8908 |
|
|
|
8909 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void *TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
|
8910 |
|
|
This hook returns the data needed by @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
|
8911 |
|
|
@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
|
8912 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8913 |
|
|
|
8914 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
|
8915 |
|
|
This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
|
8916 |
|
|
compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
|
8917 |
|
|
if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
|
8918 |
|
|
be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
|
8919 |
|
|
|
8920 |
|
|
@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
|
8921 |
|
|
when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
|
8922 |
|
|
It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
|
8923 |
|
|
compiler, so no format checking is needed.
|
8924 |
|
|
|
8925 |
|
|
The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
|
8926 |
|
|
suitable for most targets.
|
8927 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8928 |
|
|
|
8929 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
|
8930 |
|
|
If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
|
8931 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
|
8932 |
|
|
of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
|
8933 |
|
|
@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
|
8934 |
|
|
value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
|
8935 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8936 |
|
|
|
8937 |
|
|
@node C++ ABI
|
8938 |
|
|
@section C++ ABI parameters
|
8939 |
|
|
@cindex parameters, c++ abi
|
8940 |
|
|
|
8941 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
|
8942 |
|
|
Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
|
8943 |
|
|
These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
|
8944 |
|
|
default is long_long_integer_type_node.
|
8945 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8946 |
|
|
|
8947 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
|
8948 |
|
|
This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
|
8949 |
|
|
@code{false} (the default) if first byte should be used. A return value of
|
8950 |
|
|
@code{true} indicates the least significant bit should be used.
|
8951 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8952 |
|
|
|
8953 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
|
8954 |
|
|
This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
|
8955 |
|
|
whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
|
8956 |
|
|
known that a cookie is needed. The default is
|
8957 |
|
|
@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
|
8958 |
|
|
IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
|
8959 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8960 |
|
|
|
8961 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
|
8962 |
|
|
This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
|
8963 |
|
|
array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
|
8964 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8965 |
|
|
|
8966 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
|
8967 |
|
|
If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
|
8968 |
|
|
class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
|
8969 |
|
|
will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
|
8970 |
|
|
to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
|
8971 |
|
|
modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
|
8972 |
|
|
backend's targeted operating system.
|
8973 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8974 |
|
|
|
8975 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
|
8976 |
|
|
This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
|
8977 |
|
|
the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
|
8978 |
|
|
@code{false}.
|
8979 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8980 |
|
|
|
8981 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
|
8982 |
|
|
This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
|
8983 |
|
|
which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
|
8984 |
|
|
table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
|
8985 |
|
|
Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
|
8986 |
|
|
the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
|
8987 |
|
|
some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
|
8988 |
|
|
method. The default is to return @code{true}.
|
8989 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8990 |
|
|
|
8991 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
|
8992 |
|
|
@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object,
|
8993 |
|
|
or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with
|
8994 |
|
|
external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been
|
8995 |
|
|
explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility
|
8996 |
|
|
other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set
|
8997 |
|
|
@code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
|
8998 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
8999 |
|
|
|
9000 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
|
9001 |
|
|
This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
|
9002 |
|
|
similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
|
9003 |
|
|
external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
|
9004 |
|
|
classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
|
9005 |
|
|
unit will not be COMDAT.
|
9006 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9007 |
|
|
|
9008 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
|
9009 |
|
|
This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
|
9010 |
|
|
should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
|
9011 |
|
|
is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
|
9012 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9013 |
|
|
|
9014 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
|
9015 |
|
|
@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been
|
9016 |
|
|
defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak
|
9017 |
|
|
visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
|
9018 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9019 |
|
|
|
9020 |
|
|
@node Misc
|
9021 |
|
|
@section Miscellaneous Parameters
|
9022 |
|
|
@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
|
9023 |
|
|
|
9024 |
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
9025 |
|
|
Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
|
9026 |
|
|
|
9027 |
|
|
@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
|
9028 |
|
|
Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
|
9029 |
|
|
has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
|
9030 |
|
|
conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
|
9031 |
|
|
blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
|
9032 |
|
|
set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
|
9033 |
|
|
to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
|
9034 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9035 |
|
|
|
9036 |
|
|
@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
|
9037 |
|
|
Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
|
9038 |
|
|
has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
|
9039 |
|
|
conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
|
9040 |
|
|
blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
|
9041 |
|
|
set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
|
9042 |
|
|
to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
|
9043 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9044 |
|
|
|
9045 |
|
|
@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
|
9046 |
|
|
An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
|
9047 |
|
|
elements of a jump-table should have.
|
9048 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9049 |
|
|
|
9050 |
|
|
@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
|
9051 |
|
|
Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
|
9052 |
|
|
when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
|
9053 |
|
|
it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
|
9054 |
|
|
To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
|
9055 |
|
|
make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
|
9056 |
|
|
The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
|
9057 |
|
|
flags can be updated.
|
9058 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9059 |
|
|
|
9060 |
|
|
@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
|
9061 |
|
|
Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
|
9062 |
|
|
should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
|
9063 |
|
|
jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
|
9064 |
|
|
contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
|
9065 |
|
|
is in effect.
|
9066 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9067 |
|
|
|
9068 |
|
|
@defmac CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
|
9069 |
|
|
Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
|
9070 |
|
|
is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
|
9071 |
|
|
The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
|
9072 |
|
|
five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
|
9073 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9074 |
|
|
|
9075 |
|
|
@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
|
9076 |
|
|
Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
|
9077 |
|
|
statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
|
9078 |
|
|
advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
|
9079 |
|
|
of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
|
9080 |
|
|
targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
|
9081 |
|
|
@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
|
9082 |
|
|
@code{false} otherwise.
|
9083 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9084 |
|
|
|
9085 |
|
|
@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
|
9086 |
|
|
Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
|
9087 |
|
|
smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
|
9088 |
|
|
Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
|
9089 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9090 |
|
|
|
9091 |
|
|
@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
|
9092 |
|
|
Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
|
9093 |
|
|
memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
|
9094 |
|
|
bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
|
9095 |
|
|
zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
|
9096 |
|
|
of @var{mem_mode} for which the
|
9097 |
|
|
insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
|
9098 |
|
|
@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
|
9099 |
|
|
|
9100 |
|
|
This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
|
9101 |
|
|
greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
|
9102 |
|
|
value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
|
9103 |
|
|
@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
|
9104 |
|
|
define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
|
9105 |
|
|
|
9106 |
|
|
You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
|
9107 |
|
|
the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
|
9108 |
|
|
of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
|
9109 |
|
|
when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
|
9110 |
|
|
integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
|
9111 |
|
|
|
9112 |
|
|
You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
|
9113 |
|
|
mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
|
9114 |
|
|
@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
|
9115 |
|
|
is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
|
9116 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9117 |
|
|
|
9118 |
|
|
@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
|
9119 |
|
|
Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
|
9120 |
|
|
extends.
|
9121 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9122 |
|
|
|
9123 |
|
|
@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
|
9124 |
|
|
Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
|
9125 |
|
|
point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
|
9126 |
|
|
unsigned one.
|
9127 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9128 |
|
|
|
9129 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
|
9130 |
|
|
When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
|
9131 |
|
|
divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
|
9132 |
|
|
the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
|
9133 |
|
|
that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
|
9134 |
|
|
of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
|
9135 |
|
|
has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
|
9136 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9137 |
|
|
|
9138 |
|
|
@defmac MOVE_MAX
|
9139 |
|
|
The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
|
9140 |
|
|
between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
|
9141 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9142 |
|
|
|
9143 |
|
|
@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
|
9144 |
|
|
The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
|
9145 |
|
|
between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
|
9146 |
|
|
is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
|
9147 |
|
|
constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
|
9148 |
|
|
at run-time.
|
9149 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9150 |
|
|
|
9151 |
|
|
@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
|
9152 |
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
|
9153 |
|
|
actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
|
9154 |
|
|
of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
|
9155 |
|
|
this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
|
9156 |
|
|
a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
|
9157 |
|
|
truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
|
9158 |
|
|
instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
|
9159 |
|
|
include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
|
9160 |
|
|
also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
|
9161 |
|
|
arguments to bit-field instructions.
|
9162 |
|
|
|
9163 |
|
|
If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
|
9164 |
|
|
position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
|
9165 |
|
|
instructions exist, you should define this macro.
|
9166 |
|
|
|
9167 |
|
|
However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
|
9168 |
|
|
only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
|
9169 |
|
|
bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
|
9170 |
|
|
such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
|
9171 |
|
|
the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
|
9172 |
|
|
|
9173 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
|
9174 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9175 |
|
|
|
9176 |
|
|
@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
|
9177 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
|
9178 |
|
|
This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
|
9179 |
|
|
deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
|
9180 |
|
|
@xref{shift patterns}.
|
9181 |
|
|
|
9182 |
|
|
On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
|
9183 |
|
|
shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
|
9184 |
|
|
equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
|
9185 |
|
|
this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
|
9186 |
|
|
otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
|
9187 |
|
|
particular behavior is guaranteed.
|
9188 |
|
|
|
9189 |
|
|
Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
|
9190 |
|
|
@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
|
9191 |
|
|
that are generated by the named shift patterns.
|
9192 |
|
|
|
9193 |
|
|
The default implementation of this function returns
|
9194 |
|
|
@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
|
9195 |
|
|
and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
|
9196 |
|
|
@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
|
9197 |
|
|
nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
|
9198 |
|
|
by overriding it.
|
9199 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9200 |
|
|
|
9201 |
|
|
@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
|
9202 |
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
|
9203 |
|
|
``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
|
9204 |
|
|
bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
|
9205 |
|
|
operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
|
9206 |
|
|
|
9207 |
|
|
On many machines, this expression can be 1.
|
9208 |
|
|
|
9209 |
|
|
@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
|
9210 |
|
|
@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
|
9211 |
|
|
When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
|
9212 |
|
|
modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
|
9213 |
|
|
If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
|
9214 |
|
|
such cases may improve things.
|
9215 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9216 |
|
|
|
9217 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
|
9218 |
|
|
The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
|
9219 |
|
|
are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
|
9220 |
|
|
@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
|
9221 |
|
|
sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
|
9222 |
|
|
otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
|
9223 |
|
|
representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
|
9224 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
|
9225 |
|
|
@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
|
9226 |
|
|
@var{mode} to @var{mode_rep} so that @var{mode_rep} is not the next
|
9227 |
|
|
widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
|
9228 |
|
|
|
9229 |
|
|
Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
|
9230 |
|
|
value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
|
9231 |
|
|
as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
|
9232 |
|
|
@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
|
9233 |
|
|
|
9234 |
|
|
Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
|
9235 |
|
|
describe two related properties. If you define
|
9236 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
|
9237 |
|
|
to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
|
9238 |
|
|
extension.
|
9239 |
|
|
|
9240 |
|
|
In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
|
9241 |
|
|
@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
|
9242 |
|
|
@code{mode}.
|
9243 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9244 |
|
|
|
9245 |
|
|
@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
9246 |
|
|
A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
|
9247 |
|
|
with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
|
9248 |
|
|
(@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true. This description must
|
9249 |
|
|
apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
|
9250 |
|
|
comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
|
9251 |
|
|
|
9252 |
|
|
A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
|
9253 |
|
|
comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
|
9254 |
|
|
and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
|
9255 |
|
|
which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
|
9256 |
|
|
true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
|
9257 |
|
|
operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
|
9258 |
|
|
@samp{s@var{cond}} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
|
9259 |
|
|
@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
|
9260 |
|
|
the compiler.
|
9261 |
|
|
|
9262 |
|
|
If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
|
9263 |
|
|
generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
|
9264 |
|
|
replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
|
9265 |
|
|
the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
|
9266 |
|
|
For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
|
9267 |
|
|
@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
|
9268 |
|
|
@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
|
9269 |
|
|
expression
|
9270 |
|
|
|
9271 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
9272 |
|
|
(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
|
9273 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
9274 |
|
|
|
9275 |
|
|
@noindent
|
9276 |
|
|
can be converted to
|
9277 |
|
|
|
9278 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
9279 |
|
|
(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
|
9280 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
9281 |
|
|
|
9282 |
|
|
@noindent
|
9283 |
|
|
where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
|
9284 |
|
|
tested into the sign bit.
|
9285 |
|
|
|
9286 |
|
|
There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
|
9287 |
|
|
for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
|
9288 |
|
|
but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
|
9289 |
|
|
are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
|
9290 |
|
|
perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
|
9291 |
|
|
comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
|
9292 |
|
|
|
9293 |
|
|
Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
|
9294 |
|
|
from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
|
9295 |
|
|
choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
|
9296 |
|
|
to be used:
|
9297 |
|
|
|
9298 |
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
9299 |
|
|
@item
|
9300 |
|
|
Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
|
9301 |
|
|
@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
|
9302 |
|
|
``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
|
9303 |
|
|
comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
|
9304 |
|
|
combine the normalization with other operations.
|
9305 |
|
|
|
9306 |
|
|
@item
|
9307 |
|
|
For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
|
9308 |
|
|
slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
|
9309 |
|
|
other machines.
|
9310 |
|
|
|
9311 |
|
|
@item
|
9312 |
|
|
As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
|
9313 |
|
|
exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
|
9314 |
|
|
others.
|
9315 |
|
|
|
9316 |
|
|
@item
|
9317 |
|
|
Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
|
9318 |
|
|
@end itemize
|
9319 |
|
|
|
9320 |
|
|
Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
|
9321 |
|
|
@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
|
9322 |
|
|
instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
|
9323 |
|
|
those cases, e.g., one matching
|
9324 |
|
|
|
9325 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
9326 |
|
|
(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
|
9327 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
9328 |
|
|
|
9329 |
|
|
Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
|
9330 |
|
|
condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
|
9331 |
|
|
@samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
|
9332 |
|
|
machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
|
9333 |
|
|
and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
|
9334 |
|
|
@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
|
9335 |
|
|
@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
|
9336 |
|
|
find such instruction sequences on other machines.
|
9337 |
|
|
|
9338 |
|
|
If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
|
9339 |
|
|
not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
|
9340 |
|
|
instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
|
9341 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9342 |
|
|
|
9343 |
|
|
@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
|
9344 |
|
|
A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
|
9345 |
|
|
returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
|
9346 |
|
|
Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
|
9347 |
|
|
floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
|
9348 |
|
|
this macro.
|
9349 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9350 |
|
|
|
9351 |
|
|
@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
|
9352 |
|
|
A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
|
9353 |
|
|
for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
|
9354 |
|
|
mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
|
9355 |
|
|
this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
|
9356 |
|
|
return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
|
9357 |
|
|
this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
|
9358 |
|
|
@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
|
9359 |
|
|
the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
|
9360 |
|
|
given mode.
|
9361 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9362 |
|
|
|
9363 |
|
|
@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
|
9364 |
|
|
@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
|
9365 |
|
|
A C expression that evaluates to true if the architecture defines a value
|
9366 |
|
|
for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand. If so, @var{value}
|
9367 |
|
|
should be set to this value. If this macro is not defined, the value of
|
9368 |
|
|
@code{clz} or @code{ctz} is assumed to be undefined.
|
9369 |
|
|
|
9370 |
|
|
This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
|
9371 |
|
|
relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
|
9372 |
|
|
is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases.
|
9373 |
|
|
|
9374 |
|
|
Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
|
9375 |
|
|
and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
|
9376 |
|
|
visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
|
9377 |
|
|
to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
|
9378 |
|
|
breaking the API@.
|
9379 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9380 |
|
|
|
9381 |
|
|
@defmac Pmode
|
9382 |
|
|
An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
|
9383 |
|
|
this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
|
9384 |
|
|
pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
|
9385 |
|
|
On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
|
9386 |
|
|
modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
|
9387 |
|
|
|
9388 |
|
|
The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
|
9389 |
|
|
@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
|
9390 |
|
|
@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
|
9391 |
|
|
to @code{Pmode}.
|
9392 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9393 |
|
|
|
9394 |
|
|
@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
|
9395 |
|
|
An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
|
9396 |
|
|
being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most machines this
|
9397 |
|
|
should be @code{QImode}.
|
9398 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9399 |
|
|
|
9400 |
|
|
@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
|
9401 |
|
|
In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
|
9402 |
|
|
constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
|
9403 |
|
|
hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
|
9404 |
|
|
where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
|
9405 |
|
|
strict conformance to the C Standard.
|
9406 |
|
|
|
9407 |
|
|
Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
|
9408 |
|
|
convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
|
9409 |
|
|
files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
|
9410 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9411 |
|
|
|
9412 |
|
|
@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
|
9413 |
|
|
Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
|
9414 |
|
|
This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
|
9415 |
|
|
C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
|
9416 |
|
|
@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
|
9417 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9418 |
|
|
|
9419 |
|
|
@findex #pragma
|
9420 |
|
|
@findex pragma
|
9421 |
|
|
@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
|
9422 |
|
|
Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
|
9423 |
|
|
If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
|
9424 |
|
|
@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
|
9425 |
|
|
for each pragma. The macro may also do any
|
9426 |
|
|
setup required for the pragmas.
|
9427 |
|
|
|
9428 |
|
|
The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
|
9429 |
|
|
other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
|
9430 |
|
|
definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
|
9431 |
|
|
|
9432 |
|
|
If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
|
9433 |
|
|
defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
|
9434 |
|
|
|
9435 |
|
|
Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
|
9436 |
|
|
@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
|
9437 |
|
|
silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
|
9438 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9439 |
|
|
|
9440 |
|
|
@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
|
9441 |
|
|
@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
|
9442 |
|
|
|
9443 |
|
|
Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
|
9444 |
|
|
@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
|
9445 |
|
|
@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
|
9446 |
|
|
pragma of the form
|
9447 |
|
|
|
9448 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
9449 |
|
|
#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
|
9450 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
9451 |
|
|
|
9452 |
|
|
@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
|
9453 |
|
|
@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
|
9454 |
|
|
routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
|
9455 |
|
|
on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
|
9456 |
|
|
@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
|
9457 |
|
|
callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
|
9458 |
|
|
a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
|
9459 |
|
|
arguments of pragmas registered with
|
9460 |
|
|
@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
|
9461 |
|
|
pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
|
9462 |
|
|
|
9463 |
|
|
For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
|
9464 |
|
|
routines defined in @file{c4x-c.c}.
|
9465 |
|
|
|
9466 |
|
|
Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
|
9467 |
|
|
compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
|
9468 |
|
|
other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
|
9469 |
|
|
to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
|
9470 |
|
|
building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
|
9471 |
|
|
variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
|
9472 |
|
|
target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
|
9473 |
|
|
the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
|
9474 |
|
|
code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
|
9475 |
|
|
rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
|
9476 |
|
|
how to build this object file.
|
9477 |
|
|
@end deftypefun
|
9478 |
|
|
|
9479 |
|
|
@findex #pragma
|
9480 |
|
|
@findex pragma
|
9481 |
|
|
@defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
|
9482 |
|
|
Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
|
9483 |
|
|
pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
|
9484 |
|
|
[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
|
9485 |
|
|
|
9486 |
|
|
The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
|
9487 |
|
|
within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
|
9488 |
|
|
@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
|
9489 |
|
|
the behavior to the default.
|
9490 |
|
|
|
9491 |
|
|
A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
|
9492 |
|
|
(e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
|
9493 |
|
|
When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
|
9494 |
|
|
of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
|
9495 |
|
|
bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
|
9496 |
|
|
and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
|
9497 |
|
|
chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
|
9498 |
|
|
size is allocated).
|
9499 |
|
|
|
9500 |
|
|
If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
|
9501 |
|
|
the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
|
9502 |
|
|
used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
|
9503 |
|
|
precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
|
9504 |
|
|
may affect its placement.
|
9505 |
|
|
|
9506 |
|
|
The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
|
9507 |
|
|
@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
|
9508 |
|
|
of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
|
9509 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9510 |
|
|
|
9511 |
|
|
@findex #pragma
|
9512 |
|
|
@findex pragma
|
9513 |
|
|
@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
|
9514 |
|
|
Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
|
9515 |
|
|
style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
|
9516 |
|
|
pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
|
9517 |
|
|
alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
|
9518 |
|
|
the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
|
9519 |
|
|
pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
|
9520 |
|
|
invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
|
9521 |
|
|
that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
|
9522 |
|
|
value.
|
9523 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9524 |
|
|
|
9525 |
|
|
@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
|
9526 |
|
|
Define this macro, as well as
|
9527 |
|
|
@code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
|
9528 |
|
|
arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
|
9529 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9530 |
|
|
|
9531 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
|
9532 |
|
|
If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
|
9533 |
|
|
the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
|
9534 |
|
|
This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
|
9535 |
|
|
@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
|
9536 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9537 |
|
|
|
9538 |
|
|
@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
|
9539 |
|
|
Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
|
9540 |
|
|
identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
|
9541 |
|
|
not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
|
9542 |
|
|
there is no need to define this macro in that case.
|
9543 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9544 |
|
|
|
9545 |
|
|
@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
|
9546 |
|
|
Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
|
9547 |
|
|
@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
|
9548 |
|
|
G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
|
9549 |
|
|
@samp{.} is used instead.
|
9550 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9551 |
|
|
|
9552 |
|
|
@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
|
9553 |
|
|
Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
|
9554 |
|
|
@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
|
9555 |
|
|
have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
|
9556 |
|
|
are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
|
9557 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9558 |
|
|
|
9559 |
|
|
@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
|
9560 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
|
9561 |
|
|
delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
|
9562 |
|
|
even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
|
9563 |
|
|
@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
|
9564 |
|
|
every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
|
9565 |
|
|
or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
|
9566 |
|
|
you should define this macro.
|
9567 |
|
|
|
9568 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
|
9569 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9570 |
|
|
|
9571 |
|
|
@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
|
9572 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
|
9573 |
|
|
delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
|
9574 |
|
|
even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
|
9575 |
|
|
@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
|
9576 |
|
|
some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
|
9577 |
|
|
are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
|
9578 |
|
|
define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
|
9579 |
|
|
instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
|
9580 |
|
|
slot of @var{insn}.
|
9581 |
|
|
|
9582 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
|
9583 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9584 |
|
|
|
9585 |
|
|
@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
|
9586 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
|
9587 |
|
|
global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
|
9588 |
|
|
symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
|
9589 |
|
|
instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
|
9590 |
|
|
from shared libraries (DLLs).
|
9591 |
|
|
|
9592 |
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
|
9593 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9594 |
|
|
|
9595 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
|
9596 |
|
|
This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
|
9597 |
|
|
any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
|
9598 |
|
|
It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
|
9599 |
|
|
clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
|
9600 |
|
|
corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
|
9601 |
|
|
clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
|
9602 |
|
|
@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
|
9603 |
|
|
for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
|
9604 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9605 |
|
|
|
9606 |
|
|
@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
|
9607 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
|
9608 |
|
|
in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
|
9609 |
|
|
separate math library.
|
9610 |
|
|
|
9611 |
|
|
You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
|
9612 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9613 |
|
|
|
9614 |
|
|
@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
|
9615 |
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
|
9616 |
|
|
specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
|
9617 |
|
|
|
9618 |
|
|
You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
|
9619 |
|
|
is wrong.
|
9620 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9621 |
|
|
|
9622 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
|
9623 |
|
|
Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
|
9624 |
|
|
functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
|
9625 |
|
|
Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
|
9626 |
|
|
to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
|
9627 |
|
|
if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
|
9628 |
|
|
for cross-profiling.
|
9629 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9630 |
|
|
|
9631 |
|
|
@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
|
9632 |
|
|
|
9633 |
|
|
A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
|
9634 |
|
|
conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
|
9635 |
|
|
@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
|
9636 |
|
|
1 if it does use cc0.
|
9637 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9638 |
|
|
|
9639 |
|
|
@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
|
9640 |
|
|
Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
|
9641 |
|
|
conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
|
9642 |
|
|
@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
|
9643 |
|
|
contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
|
9644 |
|
|
and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
|
9645 |
|
|
then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
|
9646 |
|
|
@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
|
9647 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9648 |
|
|
|
9649 |
|
|
@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
|
9650 |
|
|
Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
|
9651 |
|
|
if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
|
9652 |
|
|
@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
|
9653 |
|
|
being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
|
9654 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9655 |
|
|
|
9656 |
|
|
@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
|
9657 |
|
|
A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
|
9658 |
|
|
be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
|
9659 |
|
|
a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
|
9660 |
|
|
about the currently processed blocks.
|
9661 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9662 |
|
|
|
9663 |
|
|
@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
|
9664 |
|
|
A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
|
9665 |
|
|
converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
|
9666 |
|
|
can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
|
9667 |
|
|
to by @var{ce_info}.
|
9668 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9669 |
|
|
|
9670 |
|
|
@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
|
9671 |
|
|
A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
|
9672 |
|
|
converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
|
9673 |
|
|
can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
|
9674 |
|
|
to by @var{ce_info}.
|
9675 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9676 |
|
|
|
9677 |
|
|
@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
|
9678 |
|
|
A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
|
9679 |
|
|
structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
|
9680 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9681 |
|
|
|
9682 |
|
|
@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
|
9683 |
|
|
If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
|
9684 |
|
|
added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
|
9685 |
|
|
by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
|
9686 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9687 |
|
|
|
9688 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG ()
|
9689 |
|
|
If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
|
9690 |
|
|
instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
|
9691 |
|
|
just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
|
9692 |
|
|
|
9693 |
|
|
The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
|
9694 |
|
|
it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
|
9695 |
|
|
laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
|
9696 |
|
|
Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
|
9697 |
|
|
|
9698 |
|
|
You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
|
9699 |
|
|
definition is null.
|
9700 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9701 |
|
|
|
9702 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
|
9703 |
|
|
Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
|
9704 |
|
|
that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
|
9705 |
|
|
necessary setup.
|
9706 |
|
|
|
9707 |
|
|
Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
|
9708 |
|
|
instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
|
9709 |
|
|
they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
|
9710 |
|
|
instructions or prefetch instructions).
|
9711 |
|
|
|
9712 |
|
|
To create a built-in function, call the function
|
9713 |
|
|
@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
|
9714 |
|
|
which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
|
9715 |
|
|
up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
|
9716 |
|
|
only language front ends that use those two functions will call
|
9717 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
|
9718 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9719 |
|
|
|
9720 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
|
9721 |
|
|
|
9722 |
|
|
Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
|
9723 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
|
9724 |
|
|
function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
|
9725 |
|
|
convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
|
9726 |
|
|
@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
|
9727 |
|
|
@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
|
9728 |
|
|
ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
|
9729 |
|
|
built-in function.
|
9730 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9731 |
|
|
|
9732 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{arglist})
|
9733 |
|
|
|
9734 |
|
|
Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
|
9735 |
|
|
was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
|
9736 |
|
|
@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
|
9737 |
|
|
implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
|
9738 |
|
|
declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
|
9739 |
|
|
arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
|
9740 |
|
|
complete expression that implements the operation, usually
|
9741 |
|
|
another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
|
9742 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9743 |
|
|
|
9744 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{arglist}, bool @var{ignore})
|
9745 |
|
|
|
9746 |
|
|
Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
|
9747 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
|
9748 |
|
|
built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of arguments passed to
|
9749 |
|
|
the built-in function. The result is another tree containing a
|
9750 |
|
|
simplified expression for the call's result. If @var{ignore} is true
|
9751 |
|
|
the value will be ignored.
|
9752 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9753 |
|
|
|
9754 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char * TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (rtx @var{insn})
|
9755 |
|
|
|
9756 |
|
|
Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
|
9757 |
|
|
low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string why doloop could not be applied.
|
9758 |
|
|
|
9759 |
|
|
Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
|
9760 |
|
|
instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
|
9761 |
|
|
the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
|
9762 |
|
|
By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
|
9763 |
|
|
loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
|
9764 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9765 |
|
|
|
9766 |
|
|
@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
|
9767 |
|
|
|
9768 |
|
|
Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
|
9769 |
|
|
Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
|
9770 |
|
|
@var{branch2} is possible.
|
9771 |
|
|
|
9772 |
|
|
On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
|
9773 |
|
|
filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
|
9774 |
|
|
may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
|
9775 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9776 |
|
|
|
9777 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (rtx @var{x}, @var{outer_code})
|
9778 |
|
|
This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
|
9779 |
|
|
Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
|
9780 |
|
|
PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
|
9781 |
|
|
of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
|
9782 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9783 |
|
|
|
9784 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
|
9785 |
|
|
|
9786 |
|
|
When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
|
9787 |
|
|
register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
|
9788 |
|
|
to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
|
9789 |
|
|
it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
|
9790 |
|
|
is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
|
9791 |
|
|
that had its initial value copied by using
|
9792 |
|
|
@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
|
9793 |
|
|
Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
|
9794 |
|
|
to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
|
9795 |
|
|
the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
|
9796 |
|
|
@code{MEM}.
|
9797 |
|
|
If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
|
9798 |
|
|
it might decide to use another register anyways.
|
9799 |
|
|
You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
|
9800 |
|
|
that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
|
9801 |
|
|
register in question will not be clobbered.
|
9802 |
|
|
The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
|
9803 |
|
|
allocation.
|
9804 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9805 |
|
|
|
9806 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
|
9807 |
|
|
Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
|
9808 |
|
|
files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
|
9809 |
|
|
use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
|
9810 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9811 |
|
|
|
9812 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
|
9813 |
|
|
Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
|
9814 |
|
|
automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
|
9815 |
|
|
do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
|
9816 |
|
|
executable files.
|
9817 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9818 |
|
|
|
9819 |
|
|
@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
|
9820 |
|
|
If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
|
9821 |
|
|
specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
|
9822 |
|
|
Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
|
9823 |
|
|
object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
|
9824 |
|
|
lists.
|
9825 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9826 |
|
|
|
9827 |
|
|
@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
|
9828 |
|
|
Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
|
9829 |
|
|
method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
|
9830 |
|
|
must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
|
9831 |
|
|
For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
|
9832 |
|
|
the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
|
9833 |
|
|
defined as this expression:
|
9834 |
|
|
|
9835 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
9836 |
|
|
build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
|
9837 |
|
|
build_tree_list
|
9838 |
|
|
(get_identifier ("stdcall"),
|
9839 |
|
|
NULL))
|
9840 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
9841 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9842 |
|
|
|
9843 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
|
9844 |
|
|
This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
|
9845 |
|
|
instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
|
9846 |
|
|
every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
|
9847 |
|
|
reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
|
9848 |
|
|
|
9849 |
|
|
@smallexample
|
9850 |
|
|
static bool
|
9851 |
|
|
cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
|
9852 |
|
|
@{
|
9853 |
|
|
return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
|
9854 |
|
|
@}
|
9855 |
|
|
@end smallexample
|
9856 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9857 |
|
|
|
9858 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
|
9859 |
|
|
This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
|
9860 |
|
|
optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
|
9861 |
|
|
usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
|
9862 |
|
|
re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
|
9863 |
|
|
to inter-block scheduling.
|
9864 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9865 |
|
|
|
9866 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
|
9867 |
|
|
Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
|
9868 |
|
|
registers
|
9869 |
|
|
that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
|
9870 |
|
|
returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
|
9871 |
|
|
that all target registers in the class returned by
|
9872 |
|
|
@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
|
9873 |
|
|
saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
|
9874 |
|
|
epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
|
9875 |
|
|
true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
|
9876 |
|
|
to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
|
9877 |
|
|
to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
|
9878 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9879 |
|
|
|
9880 |
|
|
@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
|
9881 |
|
|
If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
|
9882 |
|
|
that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
|
9883 |
|
|
that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
|
9884 |
|
|
constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
|
9885 |
|
|
more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
|
9886 |
|
|
system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
|
9887 |
|
|
The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
|
9888 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9889 |
|
|
|
9890 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
|
9891 |
|
|
This target hook should register any extra include files for the
|
9892 |
|
|
target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
|
9893 |
|
|
are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
|
9894 |
|
|
The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
|
9895 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9896 |
|
|
|
9897 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
|
9898 |
|
|
This target hook should register any extra include files for the
|
9899 |
|
|
target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
|
9900 |
|
|
indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
|
9901 |
|
|
@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
|
9902 |
|
|
@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
|
9903 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9904 |
|
|
|
9905 |
|
|
@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
|
9906 |
|
|
This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
|
9907 |
|
|
The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
|
9908 |
|
|
systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
|
9909 |
|
|
that are different from @option{-I}.
|
9910 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9911 |
|
|
|
9912 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
|
9913 |
|
|
This target hook returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
|
9914 |
|
|
for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
|
9915 |
|
|
@code{false} otherwise. By default, the hook returns @code{true} for all
|
9916 |
|
|
functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
|
9917 |
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
|
9918 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9919 |
|
|
|
9920 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
|
9921 |
|
|
If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
|
9922 |
|
|
target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
|
9923 |
|
|
option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
|
9924 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9925 |
|
|
|
9926 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
|
9927 |
|
|
If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
|
9928 |
|
|
@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
|
9929 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9930 |
|
|
|
9931 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
|
9932 |
|
|
If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
|
9933 |
|
|
guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
|
9934 |
|
|
main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
|
9935 |
|
|
important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
|
9936 |
|
|
many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
|
9937 |
|
|
``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
|
9938 |
|
|
and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
|
9939 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9940 |
|
|
|
9941 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (tree @var{typelist}, tree @var{funcdecl}, tree @var{val})
|
9942 |
|
|
If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
|
9943 |
|
|
illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
|
9944 |
|
|
with prototype @var{typelist}.
|
9945 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9946 |
|
|
|
9947 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (tree @var{fromtype}, tree @var{totype})
|
9948 |
|
|
If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
|
9949 |
|
|
invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
|
9950 |
|
|
if validity should be determined by the front end.
|
9951 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9952 |
|
|
|
9953 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, tree @var{type})
|
9954 |
|
|
If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
|
9955 |
|
|
invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
|
9956 |
|
|
@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
|
9957 |
|
|
if validity should be determined by the front end.
|
9958 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9959 |
|
|
|
9960 |
|
|
@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
|
9961 |
|
|
If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
|
9962 |
|
|
invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
|
9963 |
|
|
and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
|
9964 |
|
|
the front end.
|
9965 |
|
|
@end deftypefn
|
9966 |
|
|
|
9967 |
|
|
@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
|
9968 |
|
|
This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
|
9969 |
|
|
classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
|
9970 |
|
|
SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
|
9971 |
|
|
@end defmac
|
9972 |
|
|
|
9973 |
|
|
@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
|
9974 |
|
|
This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
|
9975 |
|
|
NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
|
9976 |
|
|
@end defmac
|